PR middle-end/54635
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / expr.c
blobc180e8d5edcbc3c66e38875406698b955867db3b
1 /* Convert tree expression to rtl instructions, for GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1988, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
3 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011,
4 2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6 This file is part of GCC.
8 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
9 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
10 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
11 version.
13 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
14 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
15 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
16 for more details.
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
20 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
22 #include "config.h"
23 #include "system.h"
24 #include "coretypes.h"
25 #include "tm.h"
26 #include "machmode.h"
27 #include "rtl.h"
28 #include "tree.h"
29 #include "flags.h"
30 #include "regs.h"
31 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
32 #include "except.h"
33 #include "function.h"
34 #include "insn-config.h"
35 #include "insn-attr.h"
36 /* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
37 #include "expr.h"
38 #include "optabs.h"
39 #include "libfuncs.h"
40 #include "recog.h"
41 #include "reload.h"
42 #include "typeclass.h"
43 #include "toplev.h"
44 #include "langhooks.h"
45 #include "intl.h"
46 #include "tm_p.h"
47 #include "tree-iterator.h"
48 #include "tree-flow.h"
49 #include "target.h"
50 #include "common/common-target.h"
51 #include "timevar.h"
52 #include "df.h"
53 #include "diagnostic.h"
54 #include "ssaexpand.h"
55 #include "target-globals.h"
56 #include "params.h"
58 /* Decide whether a function's arguments should be processed
59 from first to last or from last to first.
61 They should if the stack and args grow in opposite directions, but
62 only if we have push insns. */
64 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
66 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
67 #if defined (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD) != defined (ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD)
68 #define PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED /* If it's last to first. */
69 #endif
70 #endif
72 #endif
74 #ifndef STACK_PUSH_CODE
75 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
76 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_DEC
77 #else
78 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_INC
79 #endif
80 #endif
83 /* If this is nonzero, we do not bother generating VOLATILE
84 around volatile memory references, and we are willing to
85 output indirect addresses. If cse is to follow, we reject
86 indirect addresses so a useful potential cse is generated;
87 if it is used only once, instruction combination will produce
88 the same indirect address eventually. */
89 int cse_not_expected;
91 /* This structure is used by move_by_pieces to describe the move to
92 be performed. */
93 struct move_by_pieces_d
95 rtx to;
96 rtx to_addr;
97 int autinc_to;
98 int explicit_inc_to;
99 rtx from;
100 rtx from_addr;
101 int autinc_from;
102 int explicit_inc_from;
103 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
104 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
105 int reverse;
108 /* This structure is used by store_by_pieces to describe the clear to
109 be performed. */
111 struct store_by_pieces_d
113 rtx to;
114 rtx to_addr;
115 int autinc_to;
116 int explicit_inc_to;
117 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
118 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
119 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
120 void *constfundata;
121 int reverse;
124 static void move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
125 struct move_by_pieces_d *);
126 static bool block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void);
127 static bool emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
128 static tree emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int);
129 static void emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
130 static rtx clear_by_pieces_1 (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
131 static void clear_by_pieces (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
132 static void store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces_d *, unsigned int);
133 static void store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
134 struct store_by_pieces_d *);
135 static tree clear_storage_libcall_fn (int);
136 static rtx compress_float_constant (rtx, rtx);
137 static rtx get_subtarget (rtx);
138 static void store_constructor_field (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
139 HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode,
140 tree, tree, int, alias_set_type);
141 static void store_constructor (tree, rtx, int, HOST_WIDE_INT);
142 static rtx store_field (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT,
143 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
144 enum machine_mode,
145 tree, tree, alias_set_type, bool);
147 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree, const_tree);
149 static int is_aligning_offset (const_tree, const_tree);
150 static void expand_operands (tree, tree, rtx, rtx*, rtx*,
151 enum expand_modifier);
152 static rtx reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx, rtx, tree);
153 static rtx do_store_flag (sepops, rtx, enum machine_mode);
154 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
155 static void emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode, rtx, tree);
156 #endif
157 static void do_tablejump (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx);
158 static rtx const_vector_from_tree (tree);
159 static void write_complex_part (rtx, rtx, bool);
161 /* This macro is used to determine whether move_by_pieces should be called
162 to perform a structure copy. */
163 #ifndef MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
164 #define MOVE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
165 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
166 < (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
167 #endif
169 /* This macro is used to determine whether clear_by_pieces should be
170 called to clear storage. */
171 #ifndef CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P
172 #define CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
173 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
174 < (unsigned int) CLEAR_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
175 #endif
177 /* This macro is used to determine whether store_by_pieces should be
178 called to "memset" storage with byte values other than zero. */
179 #ifndef SET_BY_PIECES_P
180 #define SET_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
181 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
182 < (unsigned int) SET_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
183 #endif
185 /* This macro is used to determine whether store_by_pieces should be
186 called to "memcpy" storage when the source is a constant string. */
187 #ifndef STORE_BY_PIECES_P
188 #define STORE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
189 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
190 < (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
191 #endif
193 /* SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS is nonzero if unaligned accesses are very slow. */
195 #ifndef SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
196 #define SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS(MODE, ALIGN) STRICT_ALIGNMENT
197 #endif
199 /* This is run to set up which modes can be used
200 directly in memory and to initialize the block move optab. It is run
201 at the beginning of compilation and when the target is reinitialized. */
203 void
204 init_expr_target (void)
206 rtx insn, pat;
207 enum machine_mode mode;
208 int num_clobbers;
209 rtx mem, mem1;
210 rtx reg;
212 /* Try indexing by frame ptr and try by stack ptr.
213 It is known that on the Convex the stack ptr isn't a valid index.
214 With luck, one or the other is valid on any machine. */
215 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
216 mem1 = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, frame_pointer_rtx);
218 /* A scratch register we can modify in-place below to avoid
219 useless RTL allocations. */
220 reg = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, -1);
222 insn = rtx_alloc (INSN);
223 pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
224 PATTERN (insn) = pat;
226 for (mode = VOIDmode; (int) mode < NUM_MACHINE_MODES;
227 mode = (enum machine_mode) ((int) mode + 1))
229 int regno;
231 direct_load[(int) mode] = direct_store[(int) mode] = 0;
232 PUT_MODE (mem, mode);
233 PUT_MODE (mem1, mode);
234 PUT_MODE (reg, mode);
236 /* See if there is some register that can be used in this mode and
237 directly loaded or stored from memory. */
239 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
240 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
241 && (direct_load[(int) mode] == 0 || direct_store[(int) mode] == 0);
242 regno++)
244 if (! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, mode))
245 continue;
247 SET_REGNO (reg, regno);
249 SET_SRC (pat) = mem;
250 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
251 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
252 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
254 SET_SRC (pat) = mem1;
255 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
256 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
257 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
259 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
260 SET_DEST (pat) = mem;
261 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
262 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
264 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
265 SET_DEST (pat) = mem1;
266 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
267 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
271 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_raw_REG (Pmode, 10000));
273 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); mode != VOIDmode;
274 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
276 enum machine_mode srcmode;
277 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); srcmode != mode;
278 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
280 enum insn_code ic;
282 ic = can_extend_p (mode, srcmode, 0);
283 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
284 continue;
286 PUT_MODE (mem, srcmode);
288 if (insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, mem))
289 float_extend_from_mem[mode][srcmode] = true;
294 /* This is run at the start of compiling a function. */
296 void
297 init_expr (void)
299 memset (&crtl->expr, 0, sizeof (crtl->expr));
302 /* Copy data from FROM to TO, where the machine modes are not the same.
303 Both modes may be integer, or both may be floating, or both may be
304 fixed-point.
305 UNSIGNEDP should be nonzero if FROM is an unsigned type.
306 This causes zero-extension instead of sign-extension. */
308 void
309 convert_move (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
311 enum machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to);
312 enum machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE (from);
313 int to_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode);
314 int from_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode);
315 enum insn_code code;
316 rtx libcall;
318 /* rtx code for making an equivalent value. */
319 enum rtx_code equiv_code = (unsignedp < 0 ? UNKNOWN
320 : (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND));
323 gcc_assert (to_real == from_real);
324 gcc_assert (to_mode != BLKmode);
325 gcc_assert (from_mode != BLKmode);
327 /* If the source and destination are already the same, then there's
328 nothing to do. */
329 if (to == from)
330 return;
332 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
333 the required extension, strip it. We don't handle such SUBREGs as
334 TO here. */
336 if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from)
337 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (from)))
338 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
339 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (from) == unsignedp)
340 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, from), from_mode = to_mode;
342 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (to) != SUBREG || !SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to));
344 if (to_mode == from_mode
345 || (from_mode == VOIDmode && CONSTANT_P (from)))
347 emit_move_insn (to, from);
348 return;
351 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (from_mode))
353 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode));
355 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode))
356 from = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, from, GET_MODE (from), 0);
357 else
358 to = simplify_gen_subreg (from_mode, to, GET_MODE (to), 0);
360 emit_move_insn (to, from);
361 return;
364 if (GET_CODE (to) == CONCAT && GET_CODE (from) == CONCAT)
366 convert_move (XEXP (to, 0), XEXP (from, 0), unsignedp);
367 convert_move (XEXP (to, 1), XEXP (from, 1), unsignedp);
368 return;
371 if (to_real)
373 rtx value, insns;
374 convert_optab tab;
376 gcc_assert ((GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode)
377 != GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
378 || (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode)
379 != DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode)));
381 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) == GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
382 /* Conversion between decimal float and binary float, same size. */
383 tab = DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode) ? trunc_optab : sext_optab;
384 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
385 tab = sext_optab;
386 else
387 tab = trunc_optab;
389 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
391 code = convert_optab_handler (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
392 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
394 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from,
395 tab == sext_optab ? FLOAT_EXTEND : FLOAT_TRUNCATE);
396 return;
399 /* Otherwise use a libcall. */
400 libcall = convert_optab_libfunc (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
402 /* Is this conversion implemented yet? */
403 gcc_assert (libcall);
405 start_sequence ();
406 value = emit_library_call_value (libcall, NULL_RTX, LCT_CONST, to_mode,
407 1, from, from_mode);
408 insns = get_insns ();
409 end_sequence ();
410 emit_libcall_block (insns, to, value,
411 tab == trunc_optab ? gen_rtx_FLOAT_TRUNCATE (to_mode,
412 from)
413 : gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (to_mode, from));
414 return;
417 /* Handle pointer conversion. */ /* SPEE 900220. */
418 /* Targets are expected to provide conversion insns between PxImode and
419 xImode for all MODE_PARTIAL_INT modes they use, but no others. */
420 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
422 enum machine_mode full_mode
423 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode), MODE_INT);
425 gcc_assert (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode)
426 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
428 if (full_mode != from_mode)
429 from = convert_to_mode (full_mode, from, unsignedp);
430 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode),
431 to, from, UNKNOWN);
432 return;
434 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
436 rtx new_from;
437 enum machine_mode full_mode
438 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode), MODE_INT);
439 convert_optab ctab = unsignedp ? zext_optab : sext_optab;
440 enum insn_code icode;
442 icode = convert_optab_handler (ctab, full_mode, from_mode);
443 gcc_assert (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing);
445 if (to_mode == full_mode)
447 emit_unop_insn (icode, to, from, UNKNOWN);
448 return;
451 new_from = gen_reg_rtx (full_mode);
452 emit_unop_insn (icode, new_from, from, UNKNOWN);
454 /* else proceed to integer conversions below. */
455 from_mode = full_mode;
456 from = new_from;
459 /* Make sure both are fixed-point modes or both are not. */
460 gcc_assert (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode) ==
461 ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (to_mode));
462 if (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode))
464 /* If we widen from_mode to to_mode and they are in the same class,
465 we won't saturate the result.
466 Otherwise, always saturate the result to play safe. */
467 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode)
468 && GET_MODE_SIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
469 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 0);
470 else
471 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 1);
472 return;
475 /* Now both modes are integers. */
477 /* Handle expanding beyond a word. */
478 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
479 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
481 rtx insns;
482 rtx lowpart;
483 rtx fill_value;
484 rtx lowfrom;
485 int i;
486 enum machine_mode lowpart_mode;
487 int nwords = CEIL (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode), UNITS_PER_WORD);
489 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
490 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
491 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
493 /* If FROM is a SUBREG, put it into a register. Do this
494 so that we always generate the same set of insns for
495 better cse'ing; if an intermediate assignment occurred,
496 we won't be doing the operation directly on the SUBREG. */
497 if (optimize > 0 && GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG)
498 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
499 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
500 return;
502 /* Next, try converting via full word. */
503 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD
504 && ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, word_mode, unsignedp))
505 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
507 rtx word_to = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
508 if (REG_P (to))
510 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
511 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
512 emit_clobber (to);
514 convert_move (word_to, from, unsignedp);
515 emit_unop_insn (code, to, word_to, equiv_code);
516 return;
519 /* No special multiword conversion insn; do it by hand. */
520 start_sequence ();
522 /* Since we will turn this into a no conflict block, we must ensure the
523 the source does not overlap the target so force it into an isolated
524 register when maybe so. Likewise for any MEM input, since the
525 conversion sequence might require several references to it and we
526 must ensure we're getting the same value every time. */
528 if (MEM_P (from) || reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
529 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
531 /* Get a copy of FROM widened to a word, if necessary. */
532 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
533 lowpart_mode = word_mode;
534 else
535 lowpart_mode = from_mode;
537 lowfrom = convert_to_mode (lowpart_mode, from, unsignedp);
539 lowpart = gen_lowpart (lowpart_mode, to);
540 emit_move_insn (lowpart, lowfrom);
542 /* Compute the value to put in each remaining word. */
543 if (unsignedp)
544 fill_value = const0_rtx;
545 else
546 fill_value = emit_store_flag (gen_reg_rtx (word_mode),
547 LT, lowfrom, const0_rtx,
548 VOIDmode, 0, -1);
550 /* Fill the remaining words. */
551 for (i = GET_MODE_SIZE (lowpart_mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD; i < nwords; i++)
553 int index = (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? nwords - i - 1 : i);
554 rtx subword = operand_subword (to, index, 1, to_mode);
556 gcc_assert (subword);
558 if (fill_value != subword)
559 emit_move_insn (subword, fill_value);
562 insns = get_insns ();
563 end_sequence ();
565 emit_insn (insns);
566 return;
569 /* Truncating multi-word to a word or less. */
570 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD
571 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
573 if (!((MEM_P (from)
574 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
575 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
576 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0),
577 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from)))
578 || REG_P (from)
579 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
580 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
581 convert_move (to, gen_lowpart (word_mode, from), 0);
582 return;
585 /* Now follow all the conversions between integers
586 no more than a word long. */
588 /* For truncation, usually we can just refer to FROM in a narrower mode. */
589 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)
590 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode, from_mode))
592 if (!((MEM_P (from)
593 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
594 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
595 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0),
596 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from)))
597 || REG_P (from)
598 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
599 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
600 if (REG_P (from) && REGNO (from) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
601 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (from), to_mode))
602 from = copy_to_reg (from);
603 emit_move_insn (to, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
604 return;
607 /* Handle extension. */
608 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
610 /* Convert directly if that works. */
611 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
612 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
614 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
615 return;
617 else
619 enum machine_mode intermediate;
620 rtx tmp;
621 int shift_amount;
623 /* Search for a mode to convert via. */
624 for (intermediate = from_mode; intermediate != VOIDmode;
625 intermediate = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (intermediate))
626 if (((can_extend_p (to_mode, intermediate, unsignedp)
627 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
628 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (intermediate)
629 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode, intermediate)))
630 && (can_extend_p (intermediate, from_mode, unsignedp)
631 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
633 convert_move (to, convert_to_mode (intermediate, from,
634 unsignedp), unsignedp);
635 return;
638 /* No suitable intermediate mode.
639 Generate what we need with shifts. */
640 shift_amount = (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
641 - GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode));
642 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, force_reg (from_mode, from));
643 tmp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, from, shift_amount,
644 to, unsignedp);
645 tmp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, tmp, shift_amount,
646 to, unsignedp);
647 if (tmp != to)
648 emit_move_insn (to, tmp);
649 return;
653 /* Support special truncate insns for certain modes. */
654 if (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode,
655 from_mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
657 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, from_mode),
658 to, from, UNKNOWN);
659 return;
662 /* Handle truncation of volatile memrefs, and so on;
663 the things that couldn't be truncated directly,
664 and for which there was no special instruction.
666 ??? Code above formerly short-circuited this, for most integer
667 mode pairs, with a force_reg in from_mode followed by a recursive
668 call to this routine. Appears always to have been wrong. */
669 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
671 rtx temp = force_reg (to_mode, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
672 emit_move_insn (to, temp);
673 return;
676 /* Mode combination is not recognized. */
677 gcc_unreachable ();
680 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
681 from converting X to mode MODE.
682 Both X and MODE may be floating, or both integer.
683 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
684 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
685 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion. */
688 convert_to_mode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
690 return convert_modes (mode, VOIDmode, x, unsignedp);
693 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
694 from converting X from mode OLDMODE to mode MODE.
695 Both modes may be floating, or both integer.
696 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
698 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
699 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
701 You can give VOIDmode for OLDMODE, if you are sure X has a nonvoid mode. */
704 convert_modes (enum machine_mode mode, enum machine_mode oldmode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
706 rtx temp;
708 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
709 the required extension, strip it. */
711 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
712 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))) >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
713 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (x) == unsignedp)
714 x = gen_lowpart (mode, x);
716 if (GET_MODE (x) != VOIDmode)
717 oldmode = GET_MODE (x);
719 if (mode == oldmode)
720 return x;
722 /* There is one case that we must handle specially: If we are converting
723 a CONST_INT into a mode whose size is twice HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT and
724 we are to interpret the constant as unsigned, gen_lowpart will do
725 the wrong if the constant appears negative. What we want to do is
726 make the high-order word of the constant zero, not all ones. */
728 if (unsignedp && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
729 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
730 && CONST_INT_P (x) && INTVAL (x) < 0)
732 double_int val = double_int::from_uhwi (INTVAL (x));
734 /* We need to zero extend VAL. */
735 if (oldmode != VOIDmode)
736 val = val.zext (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode));
738 return immed_double_int_const (val, mode);
741 /* We can do this with a gen_lowpart if both desired and current modes
742 are integer, and this is either a constant integer, a register, or a
743 non-volatile MEM. Except for the constant case where MODE is no
744 wider than HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, we must be narrowing the operand. */
746 if ((CONST_INT_P (x)
747 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
748 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
749 && GET_MODE_CLASS (oldmode) == MODE_INT
750 && (CONST_DOUBLE_AS_INT_P (x)
751 || (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= GET_MODE_PRECISION (oldmode)
752 && ((MEM_P (x) && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (x)
753 && direct_load[(int) mode])
754 || (REG_P (x)
755 && (! HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
756 || HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (x), mode))
757 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (mode,
758 GET_MODE (x))))))))
760 /* ?? If we don't know OLDMODE, we have to assume here that
761 X does not need sign- or zero-extension. This may not be
762 the case, but it's the best we can do. */
763 if (CONST_INT_P (x) && oldmode != VOIDmode
764 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (oldmode))
766 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
768 /* We must sign or zero-extend in this case. Start by
769 zero-extending, then sign extend if we need to. */
770 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (oldmode);
771 if (! unsignedp
772 && val_signbit_known_set_p (oldmode, val))
773 val |= ~GET_MODE_MASK (oldmode);
775 return gen_int_mode (val, mode);
778 return gen_lowpart (mode, x);
781 /* Converting from integer constant into mode is always equivalent to an
782 subreg operation. */
783 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode) && GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
785 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode));
786 return simplify_gen_subreg (mode, x, oldmode, 0);
789 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
790 convert_move (temp, x, unsignedp);
791 return temp;
794 /* Return the largest alignment we can use for doing a move (or store)
795 of MAX_PIECES. ALIGN is the largest alignment we could use. */
797 static unsigned int
798 alignment_for_piecewise_move (unsigned int max_pieces, unsigned int align)
800 enum machine_mode tmode;
802 tmode = mode_for_size (max_pieces * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
803 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
804 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
805 else
807 enum machine_mode tmode, xmode;
809 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
810 tmode != VOIDmode;
811 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
812 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > max_pieces
813 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
814 break;
816 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
819 return align;
822 /* Return the widest integer mode no wider than SIZE. If no such mode
823 can be found, return VOIDmode. */
825 static enum machine_mode
826 widest_int_mode_for_size (unsigned int size)
828 enum machine_mode tmode, mode = VOIDmode;
830 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
831 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
832 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < size)
833 mode = tmode;
835 return mode;
838 /* STORE_MAX_PIECES is the number of bytes at a time that we can
839 store efficiently. Due to internal GCC limitations, this is
840 MOVE_MAX_PIECES limited by the number of bytes GCC can represent
841 for an immediate constant. */
843 #define STORE_MAX_PIECES MIN (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
845 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes can be moved by using several move
846 instructions. Return nonzero if a call to move_by_pieces should
847 succeed. */
850 can_move_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
851 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
853 return MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align);
856 /* Generate several move instructions to copy LEN bytes from block FROM to
857 block TO. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
859 If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
860 used to push FROM to the stack.
862 ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
864 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
865 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
866 stpcpy. */
869 move_by_pieces (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
870 unsigned int align, int endp)
872 struct move_by_pieces_d data;
873 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode;
874 enum machine_mode from_addr_mode = get_address_mode (from);
875 rtx to_addr, from_addr = XEXP (from, 0);
876 unsigned int max_size = MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
877 enum insn_code icode;
879 align = MIN (to ? MEM_ALIGN (to) : align, MEM_ALIGN (from));
881 data.offset = 0;
882 data.from_addr = from_addr;
883 if (to)
885 to_addr_mode = get_address_mode (to);
886 to_addr = XEXP (to, 0);
887 data.to = to;
888 data.autinc_to
889 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
890 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
891 data.reverse
892 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
894 else
896 to_addr_mode = VOIDmode;
897 to_addr = NULL_RTX;
898 data.to = NULL_RTX;
899 data.autinc_to = 1;
900 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
901 data.reverse = 1;
902 #else
903 data.reverse = 0;
904 #endif
906 data.to_addr = to_addr;
907 data.from = from;
908 data.autinc_from
909 = (GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_DEC
910 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_INC
911 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_DEC);
913 data.explicit_inc_from = 0;
914 data.explicit_inc_to = 0;
915 if (data.reverse) data.offset = len;
916 data.len = len;
918 /* If copying requires more than two move insns,
919 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
920 and use post-increment if available. */
921 if (!(data.autinc_from && data.autinc_to)
922 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (len, align, max_size) > 2)
924 /* Find the mode of the largest move...
925 MODE might not be used depending on the definitions of the
926 USE_* macros below. */
927 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
928 = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
930 if (USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_from)
932 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode,
933 plus_constant (from_addr_mode,
934 from_addr, len));
935 data.autinc_from = 1;
936 data.explicit_inc_from = -1;
938 if (USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.autinc_from)
940 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode, from_addr);
941 data.autinc_from = 1;
942 data.explicit_inc_from = 1;
944 if (!data.autinc_from && CONSTANT_P (from_addr))
945 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode, from_addr);
946 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
948 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
949 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
950 to_addr, len));
951 data.autinc_to = 1;
952 data.explicit_inc_to = -1;
954 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
956 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
957 data.autinc_to = 1;
958 data.explicit_inc_to = 1;
960 if (!data.autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
961 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
964 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
966 /* First move what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
967 successively smaller modes. */
969 while (max_size > 1)
971 enum machine_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
973 if (mode == VOIDmode)
974 break;
976 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
977 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
978 move_by_pieces_1 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, &data);
980 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
983 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
984 gcc_assert (!data.len);
986 if (endp)
988 rtx to1;
990 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
991 if (data.autinc_to)
993 if (endp == 2)
995 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
996 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
997 else
998 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
999 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
1000 data.to_addr,
1001 -1));
1003 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
1004 data.offset);
1006 else
1008 if (endp == 2)
1009 --data.offset;
1010 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
1012 return to1;
1014 else
1015 return data.to;
1018 /* Return number of insns required to move L bytes by pieces.
1019 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
1021 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
1022 move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l, unsigned int align,
1023 unsigned int max_size)
1025 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_insns = 0;
1027 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
1029 while (max_size > 1)
1031 enum machine_mode mode;
1032 enum insn_code icode;
1034 mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
1036 if (mode == VOIDmode)
1037 break;
1039 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1040 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1041 n_insns += l / GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), l %= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1043 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1046 gcc_assert (!l);
1047 return n_insns;
1050 /* Subroutine of move_by_pieces. Move as many bytes as appropriate
1051 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
1052 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
1054 static void
1055 move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
1056 struct move_by_pieces_d *data)
1058 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1059 rtx to1 = NULL_RTX, from1;
1061 while (data->len >= size)
1063 if (data->reverse)
1064 data->offset -= size;
1066 if (data->to)
1068 if (data->autinc_to)
1069 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
1070 data->offset);
1071 else
1072 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
1075 if (data->autinc_from)
1076 from1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->from, mode, data->from_addr,
1077 data->offset);
1078 else
1079 from1 = adjust_address (data->from, mode, data->offset);
1081 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
1082 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
1083 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1084 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from < 0)
1085 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr,
1086 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1088 if (data->to)
1089 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, from1));
1090 else
1092 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
1093 emit_single_push_insn (mode, from1, NULL);
1094 #else
1095 gcc_unreachable ();
1096 #endif
1099 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
1100 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1101 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from > 0)
1102 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1104 if (! data->reverse)
1105 data->offset += size;
1107 data->len -= size;
1111 /* Emit code to move a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
1112 string-move instructions, with multiple scalar move instructions,
1113 or with a library call.
1115 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's (perhaps inside VOLATILE) with mode BLKmode.
1116 SIZE is an rtx that says how long they are.
1117 ALIGN is the maximum alignment we can assume they have.
1118 METHOD describes what kind of copy this is, and what mechanisms may be used.
1120 Return the address of the new block, if memcpy is called and returns it,
1121 0 otherwise. */
1124 emit_block_move_hints (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
1125 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
1127 bool may_use_call;
1128 rtx retval = 0;
1129 unsigned int align;
1131 gcc_assert (size);
1132 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
1133 && INTVAL (size) == 0)
1134 return 0;
1136 switch (method)
1138 case BLOCK_OP_NORMAL:
1139 case BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL:
1140 may_use_call = true;
1141 break;
1143 case BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM:
1144 may_use_call = block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm ();
1146 /* Make inhibit_defer_pop nonzero around the library call
1147 to force it to pop the arguments right away. */
1148 NO_DEFER_POP;
1149 break;
1151 case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL:
1152 may_use_call = false;
1153 break;
1155 default:
1156 gcc_unreachable ();
1159 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y));
1160 align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
1161 gcc_assert (align >= BITS_PER_UNIT);
1163 /* Make sure we've got BLKmode addresses; store_one_arg can decide that
1164 block copy is more efficient for other large modes, e.g. DCmode. */
1165 x = adjust_address (x, BLKmode, 0);
1166 y = adjust_address (y, BLKmode, 0);
1168 /* Set MEM_SIZE as appropriate for this block copy. The main place this
1169 can be incorrect is coming from __builtin_memcpy. */
1170 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
1172 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
1173 y = shallow_copy_rtx (y);
1174 set_mem_size (x, INTVAL (size));
1175 set_mem_size (y, INTVAL (size));
1178 if (CONST_INT_P (size) && MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
1179 move_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (size), align, 0);
1180 else if (emit_block_move_via_movmem (x, y, size, align,
1181 expected_align, expected_size))
1183 else if (may_use_call
1184 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
1185 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
1187 /* Since x and y are passed to a libcall, mark the corresponding
1188 tree EXPR as addressable. */
1189 tree y_expr = MEM_EXPR (y);
1190 tree x_expr = MEM_EXPR (x);
1191 if (y_expr)
1192 mark_addressable (y_expr);
1193 if (x_expr)
1194 mark_addressable (x_expr);
1195 retval = emit_block_move_via_libcall (x, y, size,
1196 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
1199 else
1200 emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align);
1202 if (method == BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM)
1203 OK_DEFER_POP;
1205 return retval;
1209 emit_block_move (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
1211 return emit_block_move_hints (x, y, size, method, 0, -1);
1214 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Returns true if calling the
1215 block move libcall will not clobber any parameters which may have
1216 already been placed on the stack. */
1218 static bool
1219 block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void)
1221 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1222 tree fn;
1223 #endif
1225 /* If arguments are pushed on the stack, then they're safe. */
1226 if (PUSH_ARGS)
1227 return true;
1229 /* If registers go on the stack anyway, any argument is sure to clobber
1230 an outgoing argument. */
1231 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1232 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1233 /* Avoid set but not used warning if *REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE doesn't
1234 depend on its argument. */
1235 (void) fn;
1236 if (OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE ((!fn ? NULL_TREE : TREE_TYPE (fn)))
1237 && REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fn) != 0)
1238 return false;
1239 #endif
1241 /* If any argument goes in memory, then it might clobber an outgoing
1242 argument. */
1244 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far_v;
1245 cumulative_args_t args_so_far;
1246 tree fn, arg;
1248 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1249 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v, TREE_TYPE (fn), NULL_RTX, 0, 3);
1250 args_so_far = pack_cumulative_args (&args_so_far_v);
1252 arg = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fn));
1253 for ( ; arg != void_list_node ; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
1255 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (arg));
1256 rtx tmp = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, mode,
1257 NULL_TREE, true);
1258 if (!tmp || !REG_P (tmp))
1259 return false;
1260 if (targetm.calls.arg_partial_bytes (args_so_far, mode, NULL, 1))
1261 return false;
1262 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (args_so_far, mode,
1263 NULL_TREE, true);
1266 return true;
1269 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a movmem pattern;
1270 return true if successful. */
1272 static bool
1273 emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, unsigned int align,
1274 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
1276 int save_volatile_ok = volatile_ok;
1277 enum machine_mode mode;
1279 if (expected_align < align)
1280 expected_align = align;
1282 /* Since this is a move insn, we don't care about volatility. */
1283 volatile_ok = 1;
1285 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
1286 including more than one in the machine description unless
1287 the more limited one has some advantage. */
1289 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
1290 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
1292 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (movmem_optab, mode);
1294 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
1295 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
1296 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
1297 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
1298 actual mode mask. */
1299 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
1300 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
1301 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
1302 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD))
1304 struct expand_operand ops[6];
1305 unsigned int nops;
1307 /* ??? When called via emit_block_move_for_call, it'd be
1308 nice if there were some way to inform the backend, so
1309 that it doesn't fail the expansion because it thinks
1310 emitting the libcall would be more efficient. */
1311 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
1312 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6);
1314 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], x);
1315 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], y);
1316 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
1317 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[2], size, mode, true);
1318 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1319 if (nops == 6)
1321 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1322 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
1324 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
1326 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1327 return true;
1332 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1333 return false;
1336 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a call to memcpy.
1337 Return the return value from memcpy, 0 otherwise. */
1340 emit_block_move_via_libcall (rtx dst, rtx src, rtx size, bool tailcall)
1342 rtx dst_addr, src_addr;
1343 tree call_expr, fn, src_tree, dst_tree, size_tree;
1344 enum machine_mode size_mode;
1345 rtx retval;
1347 /* Emit code to copy the addresses of DST and SRC and SIZE into new
1348 pseudos. We can then place those new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and
1349 use them later. */
1351 dst_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (dst, 0));
1352 src_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (src, 0));
1354 dst_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, dst_addr);
1355 src_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, src_addr);
1357 dst_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, dst_addr);
1358 src_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, src_addr);
1360 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
1362 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
1363 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
1365 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
1366 memcpy in this context. This could be a user call to memcpy and
1367 the user may wish to examine the return value from memcpy. For
1368 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
1369 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
1371 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
1373 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (true);
1374 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, dst_tree, src_tree, size_tree);
1375 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
1377 retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
1379 return retval;
1382 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move_via_libcall. Create the tree node
1383 for the function we use for block copies. */
1385 static GTY(()) tree block_move_fn;
1387 void
1388 init_block_move_fn (const char *asmspec)
1390 if (!block_move_fn)
1392 tree args, fn, attrs, attr_args;
1394 fn = get_identifier ("memcpy");
1395 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
1396 const_ptr_type_node, sizetype,
1397 NULL_TREE);
1399 fn = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
1400 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
1401 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
1402 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
1403 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
1404 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
1405 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
1407 attr_args = build_tree_list (NULL_TREE, build_string (1, "1"));
1408 attrs = tree_cons (get_identifier ("fn spec"), attr_args, NULL);
1410 decl_attributes (&fn, attrs, ATTR_FLAG_BUILT_IN);
1412 block_move_fn = fn;
1415 if (asmspec)
1416 set_user_assembler_name (block_move_fn, asmspec);
1419 static tree
1420 emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int for_call)
1422 static bool emitted_extern;
1424 if (!block_move_fn)
1425 init_block_move_fn (NULL);
1427 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
1429 emitted_extern = true;
1430 make_decl_rtl (block_move_fn);
1433 return block_move_fn;
1436 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Copy the data via an explicit
1437 loop. This is used only when libcalls are forbidden. */
1438 /* ??? It'd be nice to copy in hunks larger than QImode. */
1440 static void
1441 emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
1442 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1444 rtx cmp_label, top_label, iter, x_addr, y_addr, tmp;
1445 enum machine_mode x_addr_mode = get_address_mode (x);
1446 enum machine_mode y_addr_mode = get_address_mode (y);
1447 enum machine_mode iter_mode;
1449 iter_mode = GET_MODE (size);
1450 if (iter_mode == VOIDmode)
1451 iter_mode = word_mode;
1453 top_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1454 cmp_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1455 iter = gen_reg_rtx (iter_mode);
1457 emit_move_insn (iter, const0_rtx);
1459 x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
1460 y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
1461 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
1463 emit_jump (cmp_label);
1464 emit_label (top_label);
1466 tmp = convert_modes (x_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1467 x_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (x_addr_mode, x_addr, tmp);
1469 if (x_addr_mode != y_addr_mode)
1470 tmp = convert_modes (y_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1471 y_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (y_addr_mode, y_addr, tmp);
1473 x = change_address (x, QImode, x_addr);
1474 y = change_address (y, QImode, y_addr);
1476 emit_move_insn (x, y);
1478 tmp = expand_simple_binop (iter_mode, PLUS, iter, const1_rtx, iter,
1479 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1480 if (tmp != iter)
1481 emit_move_insn (iter, tmp);
1483 emit_label (cmp_label);
1485 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, size, LT, NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
1486 true, top_label);
1489 /* Copy all or part of a value X into registers starting at REGNO.
1490 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1492 void
1493 move_block_to_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs, enum machine_mode mode)
1495 int i;
1496 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1497 rtx pat;
1498 rtx last;
1499 #endif
1501 if (nregs == 0)
1502 return;
1504 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
1505 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
1507 /* See if the machine can do this with a load multiple insn. */
1508 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1509 if (HAVE_load_multiple)
1511 last = get_last_insn ();
1512 pat = gen_load_multiple (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno), x,
1513 GEN_INT (nregs));
1514 if (pat)
1516 emit_insn (pat);
1517 return;
1519 else
1520 delete_insns_since (last);
1522 #endif
1524 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1525 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i),
1526 operand_subword_force (x, i, mode));
1529 /* Copy all or part of a BLKmode value X out of registers starting at REGNO.
1530 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1532 void
1533 move_block_from_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs)
1535 int i;
1537 if (nregs == 0)
1538 return;
1540 /* See if the machine can do this with a store multiple insn. */
1541 #ifdef HAVE_store_multiple
1542 if (HAVE_store_multiple)
1544 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
1545 rtx pat = gen_store_multiple (x, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno),
1546 GEN_INT (nregs));
1547 if (pat)
1549 emit_insn (pat);
1550 return;
1552 else
1553 delete_insns_since (last);
1555 #endif
1557 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1559 rtx tem = operand_subword (x, i, 1, BLKmode);
1561 gcc_assert (tem);
1563 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i));
1567 /* Generate a PARALLEL rtx for a new non-consecutive group of registers from
1568 ORIG, where ORIG is a non-consecutive group of registers represented by
1569 a PARALLEL. The clone is identical to the original except in that the
1570 original set of registers is replaced by a new set of pseudo registers.
1571 The new set has the same modes as the original set. */
1574 gen_group_rtx (rtx orig)
1576 int i, length;
1577 rtx *tmps;
1579 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (orig) == PARALLEL);
1581 length = XVECLEN (orig, 0);
1582 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, length);
1584 /* Skip a NULL entry in first slot. */
1585 i = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1;
1587 if (i)
1588 tmps[0] = 0;
1590 for (; i < length; i++)
1592 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 0));
1593 rtx offset = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 1);
1595 tmps[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_reg_rtx (mode), offset);
1598 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (orig), gen_rtvec_v (length, tmps));
1601 /* A subroutine of emit_group_load. Arguments as for emit_group_load,
1602 except that values are placed in TMPS[i], and must later be moved
1603 into corresponding XEXP (XVECEXP (DST, 0, i), 0) element. */
1605 static void
1606 emit_group_load_1 (rtx *tmps, rtx dst, rtx orig_src, tree type, int ssize)
1608 rtx src;
1609 int start, i;
1610 enum machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_src);
1612 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL);
1614 if (m != VOIDmode
1615 && !SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
1616 && !MEM_P (orig_src)
1617 && GET_CODE (orig_src) != CONCAT)
1619 enum machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1620 if (imode == BLKmode)
1621 src = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_src), ssize);
1622 else
1623 src = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
1624 if (imode != BLKmode)
1625 src = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_src), src);
1626 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1627 /* ...and back again. */
1628 if (imode != BLKmode)
1629 src = gen_lowpart (imode, src);
1630 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
1631 return;
1634 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1635 both on the stack and in registers. */
1636 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, 0), 0))
1637 start = 0;
1638 else
1639 start = 1;
1641 /* Process the pieces. */
1642 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1644 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0));
1645 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 1));
1646 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1647 int shift = 0;
1649 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
1650 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
1652 /* Arrange to shift the fragment to where it belongs.
1653 extract_bit_field loads to the lsb of the reg. */
1654 if (
1655 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
1656 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_src), type, i == start)
1657 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
1658 #else
1659 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
1660 #endif
1662 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
1663 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
1664 gcc_assert (bytelen > 0);
1667 /* If we won't be loading directly from memory, protect the real source
1668 from strange tricks we might play; but make sure that the source can
1669 be loaded directly into the destination. */
1670 src = orig_src;
1671 if (!MEM_P (orig_src)
1672 && (!CONSTANT_P (orig_src)
1673 || (GET_MODE (orig_src) != mode
1674 && GET_MODE (orig_src) != VOIDmode)))
1676 if (GET_MODE (orig_src) == VOIDmode)
1677 src = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1678 else
1679 src = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1681 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1684 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
1685 if (MEM_P (src)
1686 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (src))
1687 || MEM_ALIGN (src) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1688 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
1689 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1691 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1692 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], adjust_address (src, mode, bytepos));
1694 else if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode)
1695 && GET_MODE (src) == mode
1696 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1697 /* Let emit_move_complex do the bulk of the work. */
1698 tmps[i] = src;
1699 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONCAT)
1701 unsigned int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1702 unsigned int slen0 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)));
1704 if ((bytepos == 0 && bytelen == slen0)
1705 || (bytepos != 0 && bytepos + bytelen <= slen))
1707 /* The following assumes that the concatenated objects all
1708 have the same size. In this case, a simple calculation
1709 can be used to determine the object and the bit field
1710 to be extracted. */
1711 tmps[i] = XEXP (src, bytepos / slen0);
1712 if (! CONSTANT_P (tmps[i])
1713 && (!REG_P (tmps[i]) || GET_MODE (tmps[i]) != mode))
1714 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (tmps[i], bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1715 (bytepos % slen0) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1716 1, false, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
1718 else
1720 rtx mem;
1722 gcc_assert (!bytepos);
1723 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen);
1724 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1725 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (mem, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1726 0, 1, false, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
1729 /* FIXME: A SIMD parallel will eventually lead to a subreg of a
1730 SIMD register, which is currently broken. While we get GCC
1731 to emit proper RTL for these cases, let's dump to memory. */
1732 else if (VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dst))
1733 && REG_P (src))
1735 int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1736 rtx mem;
1738 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen);
1739 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1740 tmps[i] = adjust_address (mem, mode, (int) bytepos);
1742 else if (CONSTANT_P (src) && GET_MODE (dst) != BLKmode
1743 && XVECLEN (dst, 0) > 1)
1744 tmps[i] = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, src, GET_MODE(dst), bytepos);
1745 else if (CONSTANT_P (src))
1747 HOST_WIDE_INT len = (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen;
1749 if (len == ssize)
1750 tmps[i] = src;
1751 else
1753 rtx first, second;
1755 gcc_assert (2 * len == ssize);
1756 split_double (src, &first, &second);
1757 if (i)
1758 tmps[i] = second;
1759 else
1760 tmps[i] = first;
1763 else if (REG_P (src) && GET_MODE (src) == mode)
1764 tmps[i] = src;
1765 else
1766 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (src, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1767 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1, false, NULL_RTX,
1768 mode, mode);
1770 if (shift)
1771 tmps[i] = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
1772 shift, tmps[i], 0);
1776 /* Emit code to move a block SRC of type TYPE to a block DST,
1777 where DST is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1778 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_SRC in bytes, or -1
1779 if not known. */
1781 void
1782 emit_group_load (rtx dst, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
1784 rtx *tmps;
1785 int i;
1787 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1788 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
1790 /* Copy the extracted pieces into the proper (probable) hard regs. */
1791 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1793 rtx d = XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0);
1794 if (d == NULL)
1795 continue;
1796 emit_move_insn (d, tmps[i]);
1800 /* Similar, but load SRC into new pseudos in a format that looks like
1801 PARALLEL. This can later be fed to emit_group_move to get things
1802 in the right place. */
1805 emit_group_load_into_temps (rtx parallel, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
1807 rtvec vec;
1808 int i;
1810 vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (parallel, 0));
1811 emit_group_load_1 (&RTVEC_ELT (vec, 0), parallel, src, type, ssize);
1813 /* Convert the vector to look just like the original PARALLEL, except
1814 with the computed values. */
1815 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (parallel, 0); i++)
1817 rtx e = XVECEXP (parallel, 0, i);
1818 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
1820 if (d)
1822 d = force_reg (GET_MODE (d), RTVEC_ELT (vec, i));
1823 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), d, XEXP (e, 1));
1825 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
1828 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (parallel), vec);
1831 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to block DST, where SRC and DST are
1832 non-consecutive groups of registers, each represented by a PARALLEL. */
1834 void
1835 emit_group_move (rtx dst, rtx src)
1837 int i;
1839 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL
1840 && GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL
1841 && XVECLEN (src, 0) == XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1843 /* Skip first entry if NULL. */
1844 for (i = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1845 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0),
1846 XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0));
1849 /* Move a group of registers represented by a PARALLEL into pseudos. */
1852 emit_group_move_into_temps (rtx src)
1854 rtvec vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (src, 0));
1855 int i;
1857 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1859 rtx e = XVECEXP (src, 0, i);
1860 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
1862 if (d)
1863 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), copy_to_reg (d), XEXP (e, 1));
1864 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
1867 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (src), vec);
1870 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block ORIG_DST of type TYPE,
1871 where SRC is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1872 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_DST, or -1 if not
1873 known. */
1875 void
1876 emit_group_store (rtx orig_dst, rtx src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int ssize)
1878 rtx *tmps, dst;
1879 int start, finish, i;
1880 enum machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_dst);
1882 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL);
1884 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
1885 && !MEM_P (orig_dst) && GET_CODE (orig_dst) != CONCAT)
1887 enum machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_dst));
1888 if (imode == BLKmode)
1889 dst = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_dst), ssize);
1890 else
1891 dst = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
1892 emit_group_store (dst, src, type, ssize);
1893 if (imode != BLKmode)
1894 dst = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_dst), dst);
1895 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
1896 return;
1899 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1900 both on the stack and in registers. */
1901 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0))
1902 start = 0;
1903 else
1904 start = 1;
1905 finish = XVECLEN (src, 0);
1907 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, finish);
1909 /* Copy the (probable) hard regs into pseudos. */
1910 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
1912 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0);
1913 if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1915 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg));
1916 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], reg);
1918 else
1919 tmps[i] = reg;
1922 /* If we won't be storing directly into memory, protect the real destination
1923 from strange tricks we might play. */
1924 dst = orig_dst;
1925 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL)
1927 rtx temp;
1929 /* We can get a PARALLEL dst if there is a conditional expression in
1930 a return statement. In that case, the dst and src are the same,
1931 so no action is necessary. */
1932 if (rtx_equal_p (dst, src))
1933 return;
1935 /* It is unclear if we can ever reach here, but we may as well handle
1936 it. Allocate a temporary, and split this into a store/load to/from
1937 the temporary. */
1939 temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dst), ssize);
1940 emit_group_store (temp, src, type, ssize);
1941 emit_group_load (dst, temp, type, ssize);
1942 return;
1944 else if (!MEM_P (dst) && GET_CODE (dst) != CONCAT)
1946 enum machine_mode outer = GET_MODE (dst);
1947 enum machine_mode inner;
1948 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos;
1949 bool done = false;
1950 rtx temp;
1952 if (!REG_P (dst) || REGNO (dst) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1953 dst = gen_reg_rtx (outer);
1955 /* Make life a bit easier for combine. */
1956 /* If the first element of the vector is the low part
1957 of the destination mode, use a paradoxical subreg to
1958 initialize the destination. */
1959 if (start < finish)
1961 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[start]);
1962 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
1963 if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, start), 1)) == bytepos)
1965 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[start],
1966 inner, 0);
1967 if (temp)
1969 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
1970 done = true;
1971 start++;
1976 /* If the first element wasn't the low part, try the last. */
1977 if (!done
1978 && start < finish - 1)
1980 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[finish - 1]);
1981 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
1982 if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, finish - 1), 1)) == bytepos)
1984 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[finish - 1],
1985 inner, 0);
1986 if (temp)
1988 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
1989 done = true;
1990 finish--;
1995 /* Otherwise, simply initialize the result to zero. */
1996 if (!done)
1997 emit_move_insn (dst, CONST0_RTX (outer));
2000 /* Process the pieces. */
2001 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
2003 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 1));
2004 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
2005 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2006 unsigned int adj_bytelen = bytelen;
2007 rtx dest = dst;
2009 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
2010 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2011 adj_bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
2013 if (GET_CODE (dst) == CONCAT)
2015 if (bytepos + adj_bytelen
2016 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2017 dest = XEXP (dst, 0);
2018 else if (bytepos >= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2020 bytepos -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)));
2021 dest = XEXP (dst, 1);
2023 else
2025 enum machine_mode dest_mode = GET_MODE (dest);
2026 enum machine_mode tmp_mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
2028 gcc_assert (bytepos == 0 && XVECLEN (src, 0));
2030 if (GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (dest_mode)
2031 >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmp_mode))
2033 dest = assign_stack_temp (dest_mode,
2034 GET_MODE_SIZE (dest_mode));
2035 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest,
2036 tmp_mode,
2037 bytepos),
2038 tmps[i]);
2039 dst = dest;
2041 else
2043 dest = assign_stack_temp (tmp_mode,
2044 GET_MODE_SIZE (tmp_mode));
2045 emit_move_insn (dest, tmps[i]);
2046 dst = adjust_address (dest, dest_mode, bytepos);
2048 break;
2052 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2054 /* store_bit_field always takes its value from the lsb.
2055 Move the fragment to the lsb if it's not already there. */
2056 if (
2057 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
2058 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_dst), type, i == start)
2059 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
2060 #else
2061 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2062 #endif
2065 int shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2066 tmps[i] = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
2067 shift, tmps[i], 0);
2069 bytelen = adj_bytelen;
2072 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
2073 if (MEM_P (dest)
2074 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (dest))
2075 || MEM_ALIGN (dest) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2076 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
2077 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2078 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, mode, bytepos), tmps[i]);
2079 else
2080 store_bit_field (dest, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2081 0, 0, mode, tmps[i]);
2084 /* Copy from the pseudo into the (probable) hard reg. */
2085 if (orig_dst != dst)
2086 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
2089 /* Generate code to copy a BLKmode object of TYPE out of a
2090 set of registers starting with SRCREG into TGTBLK. If TGTBLK
2091 is null, a stack temporary is created. TGTBLK is returned.
2093 The purpose of this routine is to handle functions that return
2094 BLKmode structures in registers. Some machines (the PA for example)
2095 want to return all small structures in registers regardless of the
2096 structure's alignment. */
2099 copy_blkmode_from_reg (rtx tgtblk, rtx srcreg, tree type)
2101 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
2102 rtx src = NULL, dst = NULL;
2103 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (type), BITS_PER_WORD);
2104 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0;
2105 enum machine_mode copy_mode;
2107 if (tgtblk == 0)
2109 tgtblk = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type,
2110 (TYPE_QUALS (type)
2111 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST)),
2112 1, 1);
2113 preserve_temp_slots (tgtblk);
2116 /* This code assumes srcreg is at least a full word. If it isn't, copy it
2117 into a new pseudo which is a full word. */
2119 if (GET_MODE (srcreg) != BLKmode
2120 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (srcreg)) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
2121 srcreg = convert_to_mode (word_mode, srcreg, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
2123 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see whether
2124 SRCREG is padded on the left or on the right. If it's on the left,
2125 set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of bits to skip.
2127 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
2128 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
2129 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
2130 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
2131 end of the register. */
2132 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
2133 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (type)
2134 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2135 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
2136 padding_correction
2137 = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD) * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2139 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. If the target lives in
2140 memory, take care of not reading/writing past its end by selecting
2141 a copy mode suited to BITSIZE. This should always be possible given
2142 how it is computed.
2144 We could probably emit more efficient code for machines which do not use
2145 strict alignment, but it doesn't seem worth the effort at the current
2146 time. */
2148 copy_mode = word_mode;
2149 if (MEM_P (tgtblk))
2151 enum machine_mode mem_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
2152 if (mem_mode != BLKmode)
2153 copy_mode = mem_mode;
2156 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
2157 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2158 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2160 /* We need a new source operand each time xbitpos is on a
2161 word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
2162 (the first time through). */
2163 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
2164 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
2165 src = operand_subword_force (srcreg, xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD,
2166 GET_MODE (srcreg));
2168 /* We need a new destination operand each time bitpos is on
2169 a word boundary. */
2170 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2171 dst = operand_subword (tgtblk, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, 1, BLKmode);
2173 /* Use xbitpos for the source extraction (right justified) and
2174 bitpos for the destination store (left justified). */
2175 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 0, 0, copy_mode,
2176 extract_bit_field (src, bitsize,
2177 xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1, false,
2178 NULL_RTX, copy_mode, copy_mode));
2181 return tgtblk;
2184 /* Copy BLKmode value SRC into a register of mode MODE. Return the
2185 register if it contains any data, otherwise return null.
2187 This is used on targets that return BLKmode values in registers. */
2190 copy_blkmode_to_reg (enum machine_mode mode, tree src)
2192 int i, n_regs;
2193 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0, bytes;
2194 unsigned int bitsize;
2195 rtx *dst_words, dst, x, src_word = NULL_RTX, dst_word = NULL_RTX;
2196 enum machine_mode dst_mode;
2198 gcc_assert (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) == BLKmode);
2200 x = expand_normal (src);
2202 bytes = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (src));
2203 if (bytes == 0)
2204 return NULL_RTX;
2206 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see
2207 whether the register value should be padded on the left or on
2208 the right. Set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of padding
2209 bits needed on the left side.
2211 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
2212 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
2213 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
2214 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
2215 end of the register. */
2216 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
2217 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (TREE_TYPE (src))
2218 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2219 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
2220 padding_correction = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD)
2221 * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2223 n_regs = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
2224 dst_words = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, n_regs);
2225 bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (src)), BITS_PER_WORD);
2227 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. */
2228 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
2229 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2230 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2232 /* We need a new destination pseudo each time xbitpos is
2233 on a word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
2234 (the first time through). */
2235 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
2236 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
2238 /* Generate an appropriate register. */
2239 dst_word = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
2240 dst_words[xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD] = dst_word;
2242 /* Clear the destination before we move anything into it. */
2243 emit_move_insn (dst_word, CONST0_RTX (word_mode));
2246 /* We need a new source operand each time bitpos is on a word
2247 boundary. */
2248 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2249 src_word = operand_subword_force (x, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, BLKmode);
2251 /* Use bitpos for the source extraction (left justified) and
2252 xbitpos for the destination store (right justified). */
2253 store_bit_field (dst_word, bitsize, xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD,
2254 0, 0, word_mode,
2255 extract_bit_field (src_word, bitsize,
2256 bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1, false,
2257 NULL_RTX, word_mode, word_mode));
2260 if (mode == BLKmode)
2262 /* Find the smallest integer mode large enough to hold the
2263 entire structure. */
2264 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2265 mode != VOIDmode;
2266 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
2267 /* Have we found a large enough mode? */
2268 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= bytes)
2269 break;
2271 /* A suitable mode should have been found. */
2272 gcc_assert (mode != VOIDmode);
2275 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
2276 dst_mode = word_mode;
2277 else
2278 dst_mode = mode;
2279 dst = gen_reg_rtx (dst_mode);
2281 for (i = 0; i < n_regs; i++)
2282 emit_move_insn (operand_subword (dst, i, 0, dst_mode), dst_words[i]);
2284 if (mode != dst_mode)
2285 dst = gen_lowpart (mode, dst);
2287 return dst;
2290 /* Add a USE expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
2291 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
2293 void
2294 use_reg_mode (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg, enum machine_mode mode)
2296 gcc_assert (REG_P (reg) && REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2298 *call_fusage
2299 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (mode, gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
2302 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each of NREGS consecutive regs,
2303 starting at REGNO. All of these registers must be hard registers. */
2305 void
2306 use_regs (rtx *call_fusage, int regno, int nregs)
2308 int i;
2310 gcc_assert (regno + nregs <= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2312 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2313 use_reg (call_fusage, regno_reg_rtx[regno + i]);
2316 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each REG contained in the
2317 PARALLEL REGS. This is for calls that pass values in multiple
2318 non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
2320 void
2321 use_group_regs (rtx *call_fusage, rtx regs)
2323 int i;
2325 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); i++)
2327 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i), 0);
2329 /* A NULL entry means the parameter goes both on the stack and in
2330 registers. This can also be a MEM for targets that pass values
2331 partially on the stack and partially in registers. */
2332 if (reg != 0 && REG_P (reg))
2333 use_reg (call_fusage, reg);
2337 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
2338 assigment and the code of the expresion on the RHS is CODE. Return
2339 NULL otherwise. */
2341 static gimple
2342 get_def_for_expr (tree name, enum tree_code code)
2344 gimple def_stmt;
2346 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
2347 return NULL;
2349 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
2350 if (!def_stmt
2351 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) != code)
2352 return NULL;
2354 return def_stmt;
2357 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
2358 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
2359 assigment and the class of the expresion on the RHS is CLASS. Return
2360 NULL otherwise. */
2362 static gimple
2363 get_def_for_expr_class (tree name, enum tree_code_class tclass)
2365 gimple def_stmt;
2367 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
2368 return NULL;
2370 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
2371 if (!def_stmt
2372 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt)) != tclass)
2373 return NULL;
2375 return def_stmt;
2377 #endif
2380 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes generated by CONSTFUN can be
2381 stored to memory using several move instructions. CONSTFUNDATA is
2382 a pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2383 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
2384 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
2385 Return nonzero if a call to store_by_pieces should succeed. */
2388 can_store_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2389 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
2390 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp)
2392 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l;
2393 unsigned int max_size;
2394 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
2395 enum machine_mode mode;
2396 enum insn_code icode;
2397 int reverse;
2398 /* cst is set but not used if LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT doesn't use it. */
2399 rtx cst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
2401 if (len == 0)
2402 return 1;
2404 if (! (memsetp
2405 ? SET_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)
2406 : STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)))
2407 return 0;
2409 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (STORE_MAX_PIECES, align);
2411 /* We would first store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2412 successively smaller modes. */
2414 for (reverse = 0;
2415 reverse <= (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT || HAVE_POST_DECREMENT);
2416 reverse++)
2418 l = len;
2419 max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2420 while (max_size > 1)
2422 mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2424 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2425 break;
2427 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
2428 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
2429 && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2431 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2433 while (l >= size)
2435 if (reverse)
2436 offset -= size;
2438 cst = (*constfun) (constfundata, offset, mode);
2439 if (!targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, cst))
2440 return 0;
2442 if (!reverse)
2443 offset += size;
2445 l -= size;
2449 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2452 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2453 gcc_assert (!l);
2456 return 1;
2459 /* Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes generated by
2460 CONSTFUN to block TO. (A MEM rtx with BLKmode). CONSTFUNDATA is a
2461 pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2462 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
2463 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
2464 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
2465 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
2466 stpcpy. */
2469 store_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2470 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
2471 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp, int endp)
2473 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode = get_address_mode (to);
2474 struct store_by_pieces_d data;
2476 if (len == 0)
2478 gcc_assert (endp != 2);
2479 return to;
2482 gcc_assert (memsetp
2483 ? SET_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)
2484 : STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align));
2485 data.constfun = constfun;
2486 data.constfundata = constfundata;
2487 data.len = len;
2488 data.to = to;
2489 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2490 if (endp)
2492 rtx to1;
2494 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
2495 if (data.autinc_to)
2497 if (endp == 2)
2499 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
2500 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
2501 else
2502 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
2503 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
2504 data.to_addr,
2505 -1));
2507 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
2508 data.offset);
2510 else
2512 if (endp == 2)
2513 --data.offset;
2514 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
2516 return to1;
2518 else
2519 return data.to;
2522 /* Generate several move instructions to clear LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2523 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2525 static void
2526 clear_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
2528 struct store_by_pieces_d data;
2530 if (len == 0)
2531 return;
2533 data.constfun = clear_by_pieces_1;
2534 data.constfundata = NULL;
2535 data.len = len;
2536 data.to = to;
2537 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2540 /* Callback routine for clear_by_pieces.
2541 Return const0_rtx unconditionally. */
2543 static rtx
2544 clear_by_pieces_1 (void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2545 HOST_WIDE_INT offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2546 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2548 return const0_rtx;
2551 /* Subroutine of clear_by_pieces and store_by_pieces.
2552 Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2553 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2555 static void
2556 store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces_d *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2557 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2559 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode = get_address_mode (data->to);
2560 rtx to_addr = XEXP (data->to, 0);
2561 unsigned int max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2562 enum insn_code icode;
2564 data->offset = 0;
2565 data->to_addr = to_addr;
2566 data->autinc_to
2567 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
2568 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2570 data->explicit_inc_to = 0;
2571 data->reverse
2572 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2573 if (data->reverse)
2574 data->offset = data->len;
2576 /* If storing requires more than two move insns,
2577 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
2578 and use post-increment if available. */
2579 if (!data->autinc_to
2580 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (data->len, align, max_size) > 2)
2582 /* Determine the main mode we'll be using.
2583 MODE might not be used depending on the definitions of the
2584 USE_* macros below. */
2585 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
2586 = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2588 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data->reverse && ! data->autinc_to)
2590 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
2591 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
2592 to_addr,
2593 data->len));
2594 data->autinc_to = 1;
2595 data->explicit_inc_to = -1;
2598 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data->reverse
2599 && ! data->autinc_to)
2601 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
2602 data->autinc_to = 1;
2603 data->explicit_inc_to = 1;
2606 if ( !data->autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
2607 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
2610 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (STORE_MAX_PIECES, align);
2612 /* First store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2613 successively smaller modes. */
2615 while (max_size > 1)
2617 enum machine_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2619 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2620 break;
2622 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
2623 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2624 store_by_pieces_2 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, data);
2626 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2629 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2630 gcc_assert (!data->len);
2633 /* Subroutine of store_by_pieces_1. Store as many bytes as appropriate
2634 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
2635 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
2637 static void
2638 store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
2639 struct store_by_pieces_d *data)
2641 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2642 rtx to1, cst;
2644 while (data->len >= size)
2646 if (data->reverse)
2647 data->offset -= size;
2649 if (data->autinc_to)
2650 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
2651 data->offset);
2652 else
2653 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
2655 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
2656 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
2657 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) size)));
2659 cst = (*data->constfun) (data->constfundata, data->offset, mode);
2660 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, cst));
2662 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
2663 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
2665 if (! data->reverse)
2666 data->offset += size;
2668 data->len -= size;
2672 /* Write zeros through the storage of OBJECT. If OBJECT has BLKmode, SIZE is
2673 its length in bytes. */
2676 clear_storage_hints (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
2677 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
2679 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (object);
2680 unsigned int align;
2682 gcc_assert (method == BLOCK_OP_NORMAL || method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
2684 /* If OBJECT is not BLKmode and SIZE is the same size as its mode,
2685 just move a zero. Otherwise, do this a piece at a time. */
2686 if (mode != BLKmode
2687 && CONST_INT_P (size)
2688 && INTVAL (size) == (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2690 rtx zero = CONST0_RTX (mode);
2691 if (zero != NULL)
2693 emit_move_insn (object, zero);
2694 return NULL;
2697 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
2699 zero = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
2700 if (zero != NULL)
2702 write_complex_part (object, zero, 0);
2703 write_complex_part (object, zero, 1);
2704 return NULL;
2709 if (size == const0_rtx)
2710 return NULL;
2712 align = MEM_ALIGN (object);
2714 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
2715 && CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
2716 clear_by_pieces (object, INTVAL (size), align);
2717 else if (set_storage_via_setmem (object, size, const0_rtx, align,
2718 expected_align, expected_size))
2720 else if (ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (object)))
2721 return set_storage_via_libcall (object, size, const0_rtx,
2722 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
2723 else
2724 gcc_unreachable ();
2726 return NULL;
2730 clear_storage (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
2732 return clear_storage_hints (object, size, method, 0, -1);
2736 /* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a call to memset.
2737 Return the return value of memset, 0 otherwise. */
2740 set_storage_via_libcall (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, bool tailcall)
2742 tree call_expr, fn, object_tree, size_tree, val_tree;
2743 enum machine_mode size_mode;
2744 rtx retval;
2746 /* Emit code to copy OBJECT and SIZE into new pseudos. We can then
2747 place those into new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and use them later. */
2749 object = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (object, 0));
2751 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
2752 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
2753 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
2755 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
2756 memset in this context. This could be a user call to memset and
2757 the user may wish to examine the return value from memset. For
2758 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
2759 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
2761 object_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, object);
2762 if (!CONST_INT_P (val))
2763 val = convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), val, 1);
2764 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
2765 val_tree = make_tree (integer_type_node, val);
2767 fn = clear_storage_libcall_fn (true);
2768 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, object_tree, val_tree, size_tree);
2769 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
2771 retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
2773 return retval;
2776 /* A subroutine of set_storage_via_libcall. Create the tree node
2777 for the function we use for block clears. */
2779 tree block_clear_fn;
2781 void
2782 init_block_clear_fn (const char *asmspec)
2784 if (!block_clear_fn)
2786 tree fn, args;
2788 fn = get_identifier ("memset");
2789 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
2790 integer_type_node, sizetype,
2791 NULL_TREE);
2793 fn = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
2794 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
2795 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
2796 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
2797 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
2798 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
2799 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
2801 block_clear_fn = fn;
2804 if (asmspec)
2805 set_user_assembler_name (block_clear_fn, asmspec);
2808 static tree
2809 clear_storage_libcall_fn (int for_call)
2811 static bool emitted_extern;
2813 if (!block_clear_fn)
2814 init_block_clear_fn (NULL);
2816 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
2818 emitted_extern = true;
2819 make_decl_rtl (block_clear_fn);
2822 return block_clear_fn;
2825 /* Expand a setmem pattern; return true if successful. */
2827 bool
2828 set_storage_via_setmem (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, unsigned int align,
2829 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
2831 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
2832 including more than one in the machine description unless
2833 the more limited one has some advantage. */
2835 enum machine_mode mode;
2837 if (expected_align < align)
2838 expected_align = align;
2840 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
2841 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
2843 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (setmem_optab, mode);
2845 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
2846 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than
2847 BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT here because if SIZE is less than
2848 the mode mask, as it is returned by the macro, it will
2849 definitely be less than the actual mode mask. */
2850 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
2851 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
2852 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
2853 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD))
2855 struct expand_operand ops[6];
2856 unsigned int nops;
2858 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
2859 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6);
2861 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], object);
2862 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
2863 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[1], size, mode, true);
2864 create_convert_operand_from (&ops[2], val, byte_mode, true);
2865 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2866 if (nops == 6)
2868 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2869 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
2871 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
2872 return true;
2876 return false;
2880 /* Write to one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Write VAL to
2881 the real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if its true. */
2883 static void
2884 write_complex_part (rtx cplx, rtx val, bool imag_p)
2886 enum machine_mode cmode;
2887 enum machine_mode imode;
2888 unsigned ibitsize;
2890 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
2892 emit_move_insn (XEXP (cplx, imag_p), val);
2893 return;
2896 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
2897 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
2898 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
2900 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
2901 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
2902 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
2903 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
2904 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
2905 if (MEM_P (cplx))
2907 emit_move_insn (adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
2908 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0),
2909 val);
2910 return;
2913 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
2914 will work. This special case is important, since store_bit_field
2915 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
2916 correspond to TCmode. */
2917 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
2918 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
2919 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
2920 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
2921 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
2922 || (REG_P (cplx)
2923 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2924 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
2926 rtx part = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
2927 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
2928 if (part)
2930 emit_move_insn (part, val);
2931 return;
2933 else
2934 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
2935 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
2938 store_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0, 0, 0, imode, val);
2941 /* Extract one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Extract the
2942 real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if it's true. */
2944 static rtx
2945 read_complex_part (rtx cplx, bool imag_p)
2947 enum machine_mode cmode, imode;
2948 unsigned ibitsize;
2950 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
2951 return XEXP (cplx, imag_p);
2953 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
2954 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
2955 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
2957 /* Special case reads from complex constants that got spilled to memory. */
2958 if (MEM_P (cplx) && GET_CODE (XEXP (cplx, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
2960 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (cplx, 0));
2961 if (decl && TREE_CODE (decl) == COMPLEX_CST)
2963 tree part = imag_p ? TREE_IMAGPART (decl) : TREE_REALPART (decl);
2964 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (part))
2965 return expand_expr (part, NULL_RTX, imode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
2969 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
2970 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
2971 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
2972 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
2973 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
2974 if (MEM_P (cplx))
2975 return adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
2976 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
2978 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
2979 will work. This special case is important, since extract_bit_field
2980 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
2981 correspond to TCmode. */
2982 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
2983 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
2984 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
2985 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
2986 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
2987 || (REG_P (cplx)
2988 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2989 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
2991 rtx ret = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
2992 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
2993 if (ret)
2994 return ret;
2995 else
2996 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
2997 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
3000 return extract_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0,
3001 true, false, NULL_RTX, imode, imode);
3004 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Yet another lowpart generator.
3005 NEW_MODE and OLD_MODE are the same size. Return NULL if X cannot be
3006 represented in NEW_MODE. If FORCE is true, this will never happen, as
3007 we'll force-create a SUBREG if needed. */
3009 static rtx
3010 emit_move_change_mode (enum machine_mode new_mode,
3011 enum machine_mode old_mode, rtx x, bool force)
3013 rtx ret;
3015 if (push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
3017 ret = gen_rtx_MEM (new_mode, XEXP (x, 0));
3018 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (ret, x);
3020 else if (MEM_P (x))
3022 /* We don't have to worry about changing the address since the
3023 size in bytes is supposed to be the same. */
3024 if (reload_in_progress)
3026 /* Copy the MEM to change the mode and move any
3027 substitutions from the old MEM to the new one. */
3028 ret = adjust_address_nv (x, new_mode, 0);
3029 copy_replacements (x, ret);
3031 else
3032 ret = adjust_address (x, new_mode, 0);
3034 else
3036 /* Note that we do want simplify_subreg's behavior of validating
3037 that the new mode is ok for a hard register. If we were to use
3038 simplify_gen_subreg, we would create the subreg, but would
3039 probably run into the target not being able to implement it. */
3040 /* Except, of course, when FORCE is true, when this is exactly what
3041 we want. Which is needed for CCmodes on some targets. */
3042 if (force)
3043 ret = simplify_gen_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
3044 else
3045 ret = simplify_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
3048 return ret;
3051 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X using
3052 an integer mode of the same size as MODE. Returns the instruction
3053 emitted, or NULL if such a move could not be generated. */
3055 static rtx
3056 emit_move_via_integer (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y, bool force)
3058 enum machine_mode imode;
3059 enum insn_code code;
3061 /* There must exist a mode of the exact size we require. */
3062 imode = int_mode_for_mode (mode);
3063 if (imode == BLKmode)
3064 return NULL_RTX;
3066 /* The target must support moves in this mode. */
3067 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, imode);
3068 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3069 return NULL_RTX;
3071 x = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, x, force);
3072 if (x == NULL_RTX)
3073 return NULL_RTX;
3074 y = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, y, force);
3075 if (y == NULL_RTX)
3076 return NULL_RTX;
3077 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3080 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. X is a push_operand in MODE.
3081 Return an equivalent MEM that does not use an auto-increment. */
3083 static rtx
3084 emit_move_resolve_push (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x)
3086 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
3087 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust;
3088 rtx temp;
3090 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3091 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3092 adjust = PUSH_ROUNDING (adjust);
3093 #endif
3094 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
3095 adjust = -adjust;
3096 else if (code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
3098 rtx expr = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
3099 HOST_WIDE_INT val;
3101 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == PLUS || GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS);
3102 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (expr, 1)));
3103 val = INTVAL (XEXP (expr, 1));
3104 if (GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS)
3105 val = -val;
3106 gcc_assert (adjust == val || adjust == -val);
3107 adjust = val;
3110 /* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
3111 stack_pointer_delta. */
3112 temp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, stack_pointer_rtx,
3113 GEN_INT (adjust), stack_pointer_rtx,
3114 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3115 if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
3116 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
3118 switch (code)
3120 case PRE_INC:
3121 case PRE_DEC:
3122 case PRE_MODIFY:
3123 temp = stack_pointer_rtx;
3124 break;
3125 case POST_INC:
3126 case POST_DEC:
3127 case POST_MODIFY:
3128 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, -adjust);
3129 break;
3130 default:
3131 gcc_unreachable ();
3134 return replace_equiv_address (x, temp);
3137 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Generate a move from Y into X.
3138 X is known to satisfy push_operand, and MODE is known to be complex.
3139 Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3142 emit_move_complex_push (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3144 enum machine_mode submode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
3145 bool imag_first;
3147 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3148 unsigned int submodesize = GET_MODE_SIZE (submode);
3150 /* In case we output to the stack, but the size is smaller than the
3151 machine can push exactly, we need to use move instructions. */
3152 if (PUSH_ROUNDING (submodesize) != submodesize)
3154 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3155 return emit_move_insn (x, y);
3157 #endif
3159 /* Note that the real part always precedes the imag part in memory
3160 regardless of machine's endianness. */
3161 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
3163 case PRE_DEC:
3164 case POST_DEC:
3165 imag_first = true;
3166 break;
3167 case PRE_INC:
3168 case POST_INC:
3169 imag_first = false;
3170 break;
3171 default:
3172 gcc_unreachable ();
3175 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3176 read_complex_part (y, imag_first));
3177 return emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3178 read_complex_part (y, !imag_first));
3181 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Perform the move from Y to X
3182 via two moves of the parts. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3185 emit_move_complex_parts (rtx x, rtx y)
3187 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3188 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3189 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values. */
3190 if (!reload_completed && !reload_in_progress
3191 && REG_P (x) && !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, y))
3192 emit_clobber (x);
3194 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, false), false);
3195 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, true), true);
3197 return get_last_insn ();
3200 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3201 MODE is known to be complex. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3203 static rtx
3204 emit_move_complex (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3206 bool try_int;
3208 /* Need to take special care for pushes, to maintain proper ordering
3209 of the data, and possibly extra padding. */
3210 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3211 return emit_move_complex_push (mode, x, y);
3213 /* See if we can coerce the target into moving both values at once. */
3215 /* Move floating point as parts. */
3216 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
3217 && optab_handler (mov_optab, GET_MODE_INNER (mode)) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3218 try_int = false;
3219 /* Not possible if the values are inherently not adjacent. */
3220 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (y) == CONCAT)
3221 try_int = false;
3222 /* Is possible if both are registers (or subregs of registers). */
3223 else if (register_operand (x, mode) && register_operand (y, mode))
3224 try_int = true;
3225 /* If one of the operands is a memory, and alignment constraints
3226 are friendly enough, we may be able to do combined memory operations.
3227 We do not attempt this if Y is a constant because that combination is
3228 usually better with the by-parts thing below. */
3229 else if ((MEM_P (x) ? !CONSTANT_P (y) : MEM_P (y))
3230 && (!STRICT_ALIGNMENT
3231 || get_mode_alignment (mode) == BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT))
3232 try_int = true;
3233 else
3234 try_int = false;
3236 if (try_int)
3238 rtx ret;
3240 /* For memory to memory moves, optimal behavior can be had with the
3241 existing block move logic. */
3242 if (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y))
3244 emit_block_move (x, y, GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
3245 BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL);
3246 return get_last_insn ();
3249 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3250 if (ret)
3251 return ret;
3254 return emit_move_complex_parts (x, y);
3257 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3258 MODE is known to be MODE_CC. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3260 static rtx
3261 emit_move_ccmode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3263 rtx ret;
3265 /* Assume all MODE_CC modes are equivalent; if we have movcc, use it. */
3266 if (mode != CCmode)
3268 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (mov_optab, CCmode);
3269 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3271 x = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, x, true);
3272 y = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, y, true);
3273 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3277 /* Otherwise, find the MODE_INT mode of the same width. */
3278 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
3279 gcc_assert (ret != NULL);
3280 return ret;
3283 /* Return true if word I of OP lies entirely in the
3284 undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3286 static bool
3287 undefined_operand_subword_p (const_rtx op, int i)
3289 enum machine_mode innermode, innermostmode;
3290 int offset;
3291 if (GET_CODE (op) != SUBREG)
3292 return false;
3293 innermode = GET_MODE (op);
3294 innermostmode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op));
3295 offset = i * UNITS_PER_WORD + SUBREG_BYTE (op);
3296 /* The SUBREG_BYTE represents offset, as if the value were stored in
3297 memory, except for a paradoxical subreg where we define
3298 SUBREG_BYTE to be 0; undo this exception as in
3299 simplify_subreg. */
3300 if (SUBREG_BYTE (op) == 0
3301 && GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode))
3303 int difference = (GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) - GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode));
3304 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
3305 offset += (difference / UNITS_PER_WORD) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
3306 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
3307 offset += difference % UNITS_PER_WORD;
3309 if (offset >= GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode)
3310 || offset <= -GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
3311 return true;
3312 return false;
3315 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3316 MODE is any multi-word or full-word mode that lacks a move_insn
3317 pattern. Note that you will get better code if you define such
3318 patterns, even if they must turn into multiple assembler instructions. */
3320 static rtx
3321 emit_move_multi_word (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3323 rtx last_insn = 0;
3324 rtx seq, inner;
3325 bool need_clobber;
3326 int i;
3328 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= UNITS_PER_WORD);
3330 /* If X is a push on the stack, do the push now and replace
3331 X with a reference to the stack pointer. */
3332 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3333 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3335 /* If we are in reload, see if either operand is a MEM whose address
3336 is scheduled for replacement. */
3337 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (x)
3338 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (x, 0))) != XEXP (x, 0))
3339 x = replace_equiv_address_nv (x, inner);
3340 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (y)
3341 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (y, 0))) != XEXP (y, 0))
3342 y = replace_equiv_address_nv (y, inner);
3344 start_sequence ();
3346 need_clobber = false;
3347 for (i = 0;
3348 i < (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3349 i++)
3351 rtx xpart = operand_subword (x, i, 1, mode);
3352 rtx ypart;
3354 /* Do not generate code for a move if it would come entirely
3355 from the undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3356 if (undefined_operand_subword_p (y, i))
3357 continue;
3359 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3361 /* If we can't get a part of Y, put Y into memory if it is a
3362 constant. Otherwise, force it into a register. Then we must
3363 be able to get a part of Y. */
3364 if (ypart == 0 && CONSTANT_P (y))
3366 y = use_anchored_address (force_const_mem (mode, y));
3367 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3369 else if (ypart == 0)
3370 ypart = operand_subword_force (y, i, mode);
3372 gcc_assert (xpart && ypart);
3374 need_clobber |= (GET_CODE (xpart) == SUBREG);
3376 last_insn = emit_move_insn (xpart, ypart);
3379 seq = get_insns ();
3380 end_sequence ();
3382 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3383 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3384 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
3385 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
3386 if (x != y
3387 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
3388 && need_clobber != 0)
3389 emit_clobber (x);
3391 emit_insn (seq);
3393 return last_insn;
3396 /* Low level part of emit_move_insn.
3397 Called just like emit_move_insn, but assumes X and Y
3398 are basically valid. */
3401 emit_move_insn_1 (rtx x, rtx y)
3403 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3404 enum insn_code code;
3406 gcc_assert ((unsigned int) mode < (unsigned int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE);
3408 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
3409 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3410 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3412 /* Expand complex moves by moving real part and imag part. */
3413 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
3414 return emit_move_complex (mode, x, y);
3416 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_DECIMAL_FLOAT
3417 || ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
3419 rtx result = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3421 /* If we can't find an integer mode, use multi words. */
3422 if (result)
3423 return result;
3424 else
3425 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3428 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC)
3429 return emit_move_ccmode (mode, x, y);
3431 /* Try using a move pattern for the corresponding integer mode. This is
3432 only safe when simplify_subreg can convert MODE constants into integer
3433 constants. At present, it can only do this reliably if the value
3434 fits within a HOST_WIDE_INT. */
3435 if (!CONSTANT_P (y) || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
3437 rtx ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
3438 if (ret)
3439 return ret;
3442 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3445 /* Generate code to copy Y into X.
3446 Both Y and X must have the same mode, except that
3447 Y can be a constant with VOIDmode.
3448 This mode cannot be BLKmode; use emit_block_move for that.
3450 Return the last instruction emitted. */
3453 emit_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
3455 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3456 rtx y_cst = NULL_RTX;
3457 rtx last_insn, set;
3459 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode
3460 && (GET_MODE (y) == mode || GET_MODE (y) == VOIDmode));
3462 if (CONSTANT_P (y))
3464 if (optimize
3465 && SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
3466 && (last_insn = compress_float_constant (x, y)))
3467 return last_insn;
3469 y_cst = y;
3471 if (!targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, y))
3473 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
3475 /* If the target's cannot_force_const_mem prevented the spill,
3476 assume that the target's move expanders will also take care
3477 of the non-legitimate constant. */
3478 if (!y)
3479 y = y_cst;
3480 else
3481 y = use_anchored_address (y);
3485 /* If X or Y are memory references, verify that their addresses are valid
3486 for the machine. */
3487 if (MEM_P (x)
3488 && (! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
3489 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
3490 && ! push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x))))
3491 x = validize_mem (x);
3493 if (MEM_P (y)
3494 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (y), XEXP (y, 0),
3495 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
3496 y = validize_mem (y);
3498 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
3500 last_insn = emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
3502 if (y_cst && REG_P (x)
3503 && (set = single_set (last_insn)) != NULL_RTX
3504 && SET_DEST (set) == x
3505 && ! rtx_equal_p (y_cst, SET_SRC (set)))
3506 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, copy_rtx (y_cst));
3508 return last_insn;
3511 /* If Y is representable exactly in a narrower mode, and the target can
3512 perform the extension directly from constant or memory, then emit the
3513 move as an extension. */
3515 static rtx
3516 compress_float_constant (rtx x, rtx y)
3518 enum machine_mode dstmode = GET_MODE (x);
3519 enum machine_mode orig_srcmode = GET_MODE (y);
3520 enum machine_mode srcmode;
3521 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
3522 int oldcost, newcost;
3523 bool speed = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
3525 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, y);
3527 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (dstmode, y))
3528 oldcost = set_src_cost (y, speed);
3529 else
3530 oldcost = set_src_cost (force_const_mem (dstmode, y), speed);
3532 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (GET_MODE_CLASS (orig_srcmode));
3533 srcmode != orig_srcmode;
3534 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
3536 enum insn_code ic;
3537 rtx trunc_y, last_insn;
3539 /* Skip if the target can't extend this way. */
3540 ic = can_extend_p (dstmode, srcmode, 0);
3541 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3542 continue;
3544 /* Skip if the narrowed value isn't exact. */
3545 if (! exact_real_truncate (srcmode, &r))
3546 continue;
3548 trunc_y = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (r, srcmode);
3550 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (srcmode, trunc_y))
3552 /* Skip if the target needs extra instructions to perform
3553 the extension. */
3554 if (!insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, trunc_y))
3555 continue;
3556 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3557 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
3558 speed);
3559 if (oldcost < newcost)
3560 continue;
3562 else if (float_extend_from_mem[dstmode][srcmode])
3564 trunc_y = force_const_mem (srcmode, trunc_y);
3565 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3566 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
3567 speed);
3568 if (oldcost < newcost)
3569 continue;
3570 trunc_y = validize_mem (trunc_y);
3572 else
3573 continue;
3575 /* For CSE's benefit, force the compressed constant pool entry
3576 into a new pseudo. This constant may be used in different modes,
3577 and if not, combine will put things back together for us. */
3578 trunc_y = force_reg (srcmode, trunc_y);
3579 emit_unop_insn (ic, x, trunc_y, UNKNOWN);
3580 last_insn = get_last_insn ();
3582 if (REG_P (x))
3583 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y);
3585 return last_insn;
3588 return NULL_RTX;
3591 /* Pushing data onto the stack. */
3593 /* Push a block of length SIZE (perhaps variable)
3594 and return an rtx to address the beginning of the block.
3595 The value may be virtual_outgoing_args_rtx.
3597 EXTRA is the number of bytes of padding to push in addition to SIZE.
3598 BELOW nonzero means this padding comes at low addresses;
3599 otherwise, the padding comes at high addresses. */
3602 push_block (rtx size, int extra, int below)
3604 rtx temp;
3606 size = convert_modes (Pmode, ptr_mode, size, 1);
3607 if (CONSTANT_P (size))
3608 anti_adjust_stack (plus_constant (Pmode, size, extra));
3609 else if (REG_P (size) && extra == 0)
3610 anti_adjust_stack (size);
3611 else
3613 temp = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, size);
3614 if (extra != 0)
3615 temp = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, temp, GEN_INT (extra),
3616 temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3617 anti_adjust_stack (temp);
3620 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3621 if (0)
3622 #else
3623 if (1)
3624 #endif
3626 temp = virtual_outgoing_args_rtx;
3627 if (extra != 0 && below)
3628 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, temp, extra);
3630 else
3632 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
3633 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3634 -INTVAL (size) - (below ? 0 : extra));
3635 else if (extra != 0 && !below)
3636 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3637 negate_rtx (Pmode, plus_constant (Pmode, size,
3638 extra)));
3639 else
3640 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3641 negate_rtx (Pmode, size));
3644 return memory_address (GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), temp);
3647 /* A utility routine that returns the base of an auto-inc memory, or NULL. */
3649 static rtx
3650 mem_autoinc_base (rtx mem)
3652 if (MEM_P (mem))
3654 rtx addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
3655 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (addr)) == RTX_AUTOINC)
3656 return XEXP (addr, 0);
3658 return NULL;
3661 /* A utility routine used here, in reload, and in try_split. The insns
3662 after PREV up to and including LAST are known to adjust the stack,
3663 with a final value of END_ARGS_SIZE. Iterate backward from LAST
3664 placing notes as appropriate. PREV may be NULL, indicating the
3665 entire insn sequence prior to LAST should be scanned.
3667 The set of allowed stack pointer modifications is small:
3668 (1) One or more auto-inc style memory references (aka pushes),
3669 (2) One or more addition/subtraction with the SP as destination,
3670 (3) A single move insn with the SP as destination,
3671 (4) A call_pop insn,
3672 (5) Noreturn call insns if !ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS.
3674 Insns in the sequence that do not modify the SP are ignored,
3675 except for noreturn calls.
3677 The return value is the amount of adjustment that can be trivially
3678 verified, via immediate operand or auto-inc. If the adjustment
3679 cannot be trivially extracted, the return value is INT_MIN. */
3681 HOST_WIDE_INT
3682 find_args_size_adjust (rtx insn)
3684 rtx dest, set, pat;
3685 int i;
3687 pat = PATTERN (insn);
3688 set = NULL;
3690 /* Look for a call_pop pattern. */
3691 if (CALL_P (insn))
3693 /* We have to allow non-call_pop patterns for the case
3694 of emit_single_push_insn of a TLS address. */
3695 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
3696 return 0;
3698 /* All call_pop have a stack pointer adjust in the parallel.
3699 The call itself is always first, and the stack adjust is
3700 usually last, so search from the end. */
3701 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i > 0; --i)
3703 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
3704 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
3705 continue;
3706 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3707 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
3708 break;
3710 /* We'd better have found the stack pointer adjust. */
3711 if (i == 0)
3712 return 0;
3713 /* Fall through to process the extracted SET and DEST
3714 as if it was a standalone insn. */
3716 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET)
3717 set = pat;
3718 else if ((set = single_set (insn)) != NULL)
3720 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
3722 /* ??? Some older ports use a parallel with a stack adjust
3723 and a store for a PUSH_ROUNDING pattern, rather than a
3724 PRE/POST_MODIFY rtx. Don't force them to update yet... */
3725 /* ??? See h8300 and m68k, pushqi1. */
3726 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3728 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
3729 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
3730 continue;
3731 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3732 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
3733 break;
3735 /* We do not expect an auto-inc of the sp in the parallel. */
3736 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (dest) != stack_pointer_rtx);
3737 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
3738 != stack_pointer_rtx);
3740 if (i < 0)
3741 return 0;
3743 else
3744 return 0;
3746 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3748 /* Look for direct modifications of the stack pointer. */
3749 if (REG_P (dest) && REGNO (dest) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
3751 /* Look for a trivial adjustment, otherwise assume nothing. */
3752 /* Note that the SPU restore_stack_block pattern refers to
3753 the stack pointer in V4SImode. Consider that non-trivial. */
3754 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dest))
3755 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS
3756 && XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
3757 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)))
3758 return INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1));
3759 /* ??? Reload can generate no-op moves, which will be cleaned
3760 up later. Recognize it and continue searching. */
3761 else if (rtx_equal_p (dest, SET_SRC (set)))
3762 return 0;
3763 else
3764 return HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN;
3766 else
3768 rtx mem, addr;
3770 /* Otherwise only think about autoinc patterns. */
3771 if (mem_autoinc_base (dest) == stack_pointer_rtx)
3773 mem = dest;
3774 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
3775 != stack_pointer_rtx);
3777 else if (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set)) == stack_pointer_rtx)
3778 mem = SET_SRC (set);
3779 else
3780 return 0;
3782 addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
3783 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
3785 case PRE_INC:
3786 case POST_INC:
3787 return GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
3788 case PRE_DEC:
3789 case POST_DEC:
3790 return -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
3791 case PRE_MODIFY:
3792 case POST_MODIFY:
3793 addr = XEXP (addr, 1);
3794 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS);
3795 gcc_assert (XEXP (addr, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
3796 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (addr, 1)));
3797 return INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1));
3798 default:
3799 gcc_unreachable ();
3805 fixup_args_size_notes (rtx prev, rtx last, int end_args_size)
3807 int args_size = end_args_size;
3808 bool saw_unknown = false;
3809 rtx insn;
3811 for (insn = last; insn != prev; insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
3813 HOST_WIDE_INT this_delta;
3815 if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
3816 continue;
3818 this_delta = find_args_size_adjust (insn);
3819 if (this_delta == 0)
3821 if (!CALL_P (insn)
3822 || ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3823 || find_reg_note (insn, REG_NORETURN, NULL_RTX) == NULL_RTX)
3824 continue;
3827 gcc_assert (!saw_unknown);
3828 if (this_delta == HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN)
3829 saw_unknown = true;
3831 add_reg_note (insn, REG_ARGS_SIZE, GEN_INT (args_size));
3832 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3833 this_delta = -(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) this_delta;
3834 #endif
3835 args_size -= this_delta;
3838 return saw_unknown ? INT_MIN : args_size;
3841 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3842 /* Emit single push insn. */
3844 static void
3845 emit_single_push_insn_1 (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
3847 rtx dest_addr;
3848 unsigned rounded_size = PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3849 rtx dest;
3850 enum insn_code icode;
3852 stack_pointer_delta += PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3853 /* If there is push pattern, use it. Otherwise try old way of throwing
3854 MEM representing push operation to move expander. */
3855 icode = optab_handler (push_optab, mode);
3856 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3858 struct expand_operand ops[1];
3860 create_input_operand (&ops[0], x, mode);
3861 if (maybe_expand_insn (icode, 1, ops))
3862 return;
3864 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == rounded_size)
3865 dest_addr = gen_rtx_fmt_e (STACK_PUSH_CODE, Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
3866 /* If we are to pad downward, adjust the stack pointer first and
3867 then store X into the stack location using an offset. This is
3868 because emit_move_insn does not know how to pad; it does not have
3869 access to type. */
3870 else if (FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type) == downward)
3872 unsigned padding_size = rounded_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3873 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
3875 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
3876 expand_binop (Pmode,
3877 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3878 sub_optab,
3879 #else
3880 add_optab,
3881 #endif
3882 stack_pointer_rtx,
3883 GEN_INT (rounded_size),
3884 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
3886 offset = (HOST_WIDE_INT) padding_size;
3887 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3888 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
3889 /* We have already decremented the stack pointer, so get the
3890 previous value. */
3891 offset += (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3892 #else
3893 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC)
3894 /* We have already incremented the stack pointer, so get the
3895 previous value. */
3896 offset -= (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3897 #endif
3898 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (offset));
3900 else
3902 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3903 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC. */
3904 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3905 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size));
3906 #else
3907 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC. */
3908 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3909 GEN_INT (rounded_size));
3910 #endif
3911 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PRE_MODIFY (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, dest_addr);
3914 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, dest_addr);
3916 if (type != 0)
3918 set_mem_attributes (dest, type, 1);
3920 if (flag_optimize_sibling_calls)
3921 /* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
3922 outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
3923 from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
3924 of sibling calls. */
3925 set_mem_alias_set (dest, 0);
3927 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
3930 /* Emit and annotate a single push insn. */
3932 static void
3933 emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
3935 int delta, old_delta = stack_pointer_delta;
3936 rtx prev = get_last_insn ();
3937 rtx last;
3939 emit_single_push_insn_1 (mode, x, type);
3941 last = get_last_insn ();
3943 /* Notice the common case where we emitted exactly one insn. */
3944 if (PREV_INSN (last) == prev)
3946 add_reg_note (last, REG_ARGS_SIZE, GEN_INT (stack_pointer_delta));
3947 return;
3950 delta = fixup_args_size_notes (prev, last, stack_pointer_delta);
3951 gcc_assert (delta == INT_MIN || delta == old_delta);
3953 #endif
3955 /* Generate code to push X onto the stack, assuming it has mode MODE and
3956 type TYPE.
3957 MODE is redundant except when X is a CONST_INT (since they don't
3958 carry mode info).
3959 SIZE is an rtx for the size of data to be copied (in bytes),
3960 needed only if X is BLKmode.
3962 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume.
3964 If PARTIAL and REG are both nonzero, then copy that many of the first
3965 bytes of X into registers starting with REG, and push the rest of X.
3966 The amount of space pushed is decreased by PARTIAL bytes.
3967 REG must be a hard register in this case.
3968 If REG is zero but PARTIAL is not, take any all others actions for an
3969 argument partially in registers, but do not actually load any
3970 registers.
3972 EXTRA is the amount in bytes of extra space to leave next to this arg.
3973 This is ignored if an argument block has already been allocated.
3975 On a machine that lacks real push insns, ARGS_ADDR is the address of
3976 the bottom of the argument block for this call. We use indexing off there
3977 to store the arg. On machines with push insns, ARGS_ADDR is 0 when a
3978 argument block has not been preallocated.
3980 ARGS_SO_FAR is the size of args previously pushed for this call.
3982 REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is nonzero if functions require stack space
3983 for arguments passed in registers. If nonzero, it will be the number
3984 of bytes required. */
3986 void
3987 emit_push_insn (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, tree type, rtx size,
3988 unsigned int align, int partial, rtx reg, int extra,
3989 rtx args_addr, rtx args_so_far, int reg_parm_stack_space,
3990 rtx alignment_pad)
3992 rtx xinner;
3993 enum direction stack_direction
3994 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3995 = downward;
3996 #else
3997 = upward;
3998 #endif
4000 /* Decide where to pad the argument: `downward' for below,
4001 `upward' for above, or `none' for don't pad it.
4002 Default is below for small data on big-endian machines; else above. */
4003 enum direction where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type);
4005 /* Invert direction if stack is post-decrement.
4006 FIXME: why? */
4007 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
4008 if (where_pad != none)
4009 where_pad = (where_pad == downward ? upward : downward);
4011 xinner = x;
4013 if (mode == BLKmode
4014 || (STRICT_ALIGNMENT && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
4016 /* Copy a block into the stack, entirely or partially. */
4018 rtx temp;
4019 int used;
4020 int offset;
4021 int skip;
4023 offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4024 used = partial - offset;
4026 if (mode != BLKmode)
4028 /* A value is to be stored in an insufficiently aligned
4029 stack slot; copy via a suitably aligned slot if
4030 necessary. */
4031 size = GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
4032 if (!MEM_P (xinner))
4034 temp = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
4035 emit_move_insn (temp, xinner);
4036 xinner = temp;
4040 gcc_assert (size);
4042 /* USED is now the # of bytes we need not copy to the stack
4043 because registers will take care of them. */
4045 if (partial != 0)
4046 xinner = adjust_address (xinner, BLKmode, used);
4048 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
4049 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
4050 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
4051 by setting SKIP to 0. */
4052 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : used;
4054 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4055 /* Do it with several push insns if that doesn't take lots of insns
4056 and if there is no difficulty with push insns that skip bytes
4057 on the stack for alignment purposes. */
4058 if (args_addr == 0
4059 && PUSH_ARGS
4060 && CONST_INT_P (size)
4061 && skip == 0
4062 && MEM_ALIGN (xinner) >= align
4063 && (MOVE_BY_PIECES_P ((unsigned) INTVAL (size) - used, align))
4064 /* Here we avoid the case of a structure whose weak alignment
4065 forces many pushes of a small amount of data,
4066 and such small pushes do rounding that causes trouble. */
4067 && ((! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align))
4068 || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
4069 || (PUSH_ROUNDING (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)
4070 == (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)))
4071 && (HOST_WIDE_INT) PUSH_ROUNDING (INTVAL (size)) == INTVAL (size))
4073 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4074 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4075 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4076 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4077 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4078 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4080 move_by_pieces (NULL, xinner, INTVAL (size) - used, align, 0);
4082 else
4083 #endif /* PUSH_ROUNDING */
4085 rtx target;
4087 /* Otherwise make space on the stack and copy the data
4088 to the address of that space. */
4090 /* Deduct words put into registers from the size we must copy. */
4091 if (partial != 0)
4093 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
4094 size = GEN_INT (INTVAL (size) - used);
4095 else
4096 size = expand_binop (GET_MODE (size), sub_optab, size,
4097 GEN_INT (used), NULL_RTX, 0,
4098 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
4101 /* Get the address of the stack space.
4102 In this case, we do not deal with EXTRA separately.
4103 A single stack adjust will do. */
4104 if (! args_addr)
4106 temp = push_block (size, extra, where_pad == downward);
4107 extra = 0;
4109 else if (CONST_INT_P (args_so_far))
4110 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
4111 plus_constant (Pmode, args_addr,
4112 skip + INTVAL (args_so_far)));
4113 else
4114 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
4115 plus_constant (Pmode,
4116 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
4117 args_addr,
4118 args_so_far),
4119 skip));
4121 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
4123 /* If the source is referenced relative to the stack pointer,
4124 copy it to another register to stabilize it. We do not need
4125 to do this if we know that we won't be changing sp. */
4127 if (reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, temp)
4128 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, temp))
4129 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
4132 target = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp);
4134 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
4135 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
4136 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
4137 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
4138 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
4139 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
4140 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
4141 set_mem_align (target, align);
4143 emit_block_move (target, xinner, size, BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM);
4146 else if (partial > 0)
4148 /* Scalar partly in registers. */
4150 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
4151 int i;
4152 int not_stack;
4153 /* # bytes of start of argument
4154 that we must make space for but need not store. */
4155 int offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4156 int args_offset = INTVAL (args_so_far);
4157 int skip;
4159 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4160 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4161 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4162 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4163 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4164 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4166 /* If we make space by pushing it, we might as well push
4167 the real data. Otherwise, we can leave OFFSET nonzero
4168 and leave the space uninitialized. */
4169 if (args_addr == 0)
4170 offset = 0;
4172 /* Now NOT_STACK gets the number of words that we don't need to
4173 allocate on the stack. Convert OFFSET to words too. */
4174 not_stack = (partial - offset) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
4175 offset /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
4177 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
4178 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
4179 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
4180 by setting SKIP to 0. */
4181 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : not_stack;
4183 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
4184 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
4186 /* If X is a hard register in a non-integer mode, copy it into a pseudo;
4187 SUBREGs of such registers are not allowed. */
4188 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4189 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT))
4190 x = copy_to_reg (x);
4192 /* Loop over all the words allocated on the stack for this arg. */
4193 /* We can do it by words, because any scalar bigger than a word
4194 has a size a multiple of a word. */
4195 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
4196 for (i = not_stack; i < size; i++)
4197 #else
4198 for (i = size - 1; i >= not_stack; i--)
4199 #endif
4200 if (i >= not_stack + offset)
4201 emit_push_insn (operand_subword_force (x, i, mode),
4202 word_mode, NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX, align, 0, NULL_RTX,
4203 0, args_addr,
4204 GEN_INT (args_offset + ((i - not_stack + skip)
4205 * UNITS_PER_WORD)),
4206 reg_parm_stack_space, alignment_pad);
4208 else
4210 rtx addr;
4211 rtx dest;
4213 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4214 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4215 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4216 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4217 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4218 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4220 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4221 if (args_addr == 0 && PUSH_ARGS)
4222 emit_single_push_insn (mode, x, type);
4223 else
4224 #endif
4226 if (CONST_INT_P (args_so_far))
4227 addr
4228 = memory_address (mode,
4229 plus_constant (Pmode, args_addr,
4230 INTVAL (args_so_far)));
4231 else
4232 addr = memory_address (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, args_addr,
4233 args_so_far));
4234 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
4236 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
4237 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
4238 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
4239 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
4240 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
4241 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
4242 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
4243 set_mem_align (dest, align);
4245 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
4249 /* If part should go in registers, copy that part
4250 into the appropriate registers. Do this now, at the end,
4251 since mem-to-mem copies above may do function calls. */
4252 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0)
4254 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4255 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4256 if (GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
4257 emit_group_load (reg, x, type, -1);
4258 else
4260 gcc_assert (partial % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
4261 move_block_to_reg (REGNO (reg), x, partial / UNITS_PER_WORD, mode);
4265 if (extra && args_addr == 0 && where_pad == stack_direction)
4266 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4268 if (alignment_pad && args_addr == 0)
4269 anti_adjust_stack (alignment_pad);
4272 /* Return X if X can be used as a subtarget in a sequence of arithmetic
4273 operations. */
4275 static rtx
4276 get_subtarget (rtx x)
4278 return (optimize
4279 || x == 0
4280 /* Only registers can be subtargets. */
4281 || !REG_P (x)
4282 /* Don't use hard regs to avoid extending their life. */
4283 || REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4284 ? 0 : x);
4287 /* A subroutine of expand_assignment. Optimize FIELD op= VAL, where
4288 FIELD is a bitfield. Returns true if the optimization was successful,
4289 and there's nothing else to do. */
4291 static bool
4292 optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
4293 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
4294 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start,
4295 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end,
4296 enum machine_mode mode1, rtx str_rtx,
4297 tree to, tree src)
4299 enum machine_mode str_mode = GET_MODE (str_rtx);
4300 unsigned int str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
4301 tree op0, op1;
4302 rtx value, result;
4303 optab binop;
4304 gimple srcstmt;
4305 enum tree_code code;
4307 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
4308 || bitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
4309 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD
4310 || TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (to)
4311 || TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (to))
4312 return false;
4314 STRIP_NOPS (src);
4315 if (TREE_CODE (src) != SSA_NAME)
4316 return false;
4317 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) != INTEGER_TYPE)
4318 return false;
4320 srcstmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (src);
4321 if (!srcstmt
4322 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt)) != tcc_binary)
4323 return false;
4325 code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt);
4327 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt);
4329 /* If OP0 is an SSA_NAME, then we want to walk the use-def chain
4330 to find its initialization. Hopefully the initialization will
4331 be from a bitfield load. */
4332 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
4334 gimple op0stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (op0);
4336 /* We want to eventually have OP0 be the same as TO, which
4337 should be a bitfield. */
4338 if (!op0stmt
4339 || !is_gimple_assign (op0stmt)
4340 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (op0stmt) != TREE_CODE (to))
4341 return false;
4342 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op0stmt);
4345 op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt);
4347 if (!operand_equal_p (to, op0, 0))
4348 return false;
4350 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4352 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset1;
4354 if (str_bitsize == 0 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD)
4355 str_mode = word_mode;
4356 str_mode = get_best_mode (bitsize, bitpos,
4357 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4358 MEM_ALIGN (str_rtx), str_mode, 0);
4359 if (str_mode == VOIDmode)
4360 return false;
4361 str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
4363 offset1 = bitpos;
4364 bitpos %= str_bitsize;
4365 offset1 = (offset1 - bitpos) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
4366 str_rtx = adjust_address (str_rtx, str_mode, offset1);
4368 else if (!REG_P (str_rtx) && GET_CODE (str_rtx) != SUBREG)
4369 return false;
4371 /* If the bit field covers the whole REG/MEM, store_field
4372 will likely generate better code. */
4373 if (bitsize >= str_bitsize)
4374 return false;
4376 /* We can't handle fields split across multiple entities. */
4377 if (bitpos + bitsize > str_bitsize)
4378 return false;
4380 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
4381 bitpos = str_bitsize - bitpos - bitsize;
4383 switch (code)
4385 case PLUS_EXPR:
4386 case MINUS_EXPR:
4387 /* For now, just optimize the case of the topmost bitfield
4388 where we don't need to do any masking and also
4389 1 bit bitfields where xor can be used.
4390 We might win by one instruction for the other bitfields
4391 too if insv/extv instructions aren't used, so that
4392 can be added later. */
4393 if (bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize
4394 && (bitsize != 1 || TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST))
4395 break;
4397 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4398 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
4399 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4400 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4402 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4403 we can alias adjacent data. */
4404 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4406 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4407 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4408 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4411 binop = code == PLUS_EXPR ? add_optab : sub_optab;
4412 if (bitsize == 1 && bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
4414 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, const1_rtx, NULL);
4415 binop = xor_optab;
4417 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value, bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
4418 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
4419 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4420 if (result != str_rtx)
4421 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4422 return true;
4424 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
4425 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
4426 if (TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST)
4427 break;
4428 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4429 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
4430 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4431 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4433 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4434 we can alias adjacent data. */
4435 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4437 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4438 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4439 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4442 binop = code == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? ior_optab : xor_optab;
4443 if (bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
4445 rtx mask = GEN_INT (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1);
4446 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, mask, NULL_RTX);
4448 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value, bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
4449 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
4450 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4451 if (result != str_rtx)
4452 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4453 return true;
4455 default:
4456 break;
4459 return false;
4462 /* In the C++ memory model, consecutive bit fields in a structure are
4463 considered one memory location.
4465 Given a COMPONENT_REF EXP at position (BITPOS, OFFSET), this function
4466 returns the bit range of consecutive bits in which this COMPONENT_REF
4467 belongs. The values are returned in *BITSTART and *BITEND. *BITPOS
4468 and *OFFSET may be adjusted in the process.
4470 If the access does not need to be restricted, 0 is returned in both
4471 *BITSTART and *BITEND. */
4473 static void
4474 get_bit_range (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *bitstart,
4475 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *bitend,
4476 tree exp,
4477 HOST_WIDE_INT *bitpos,
4478 tree *offset)
4480 HOST_WIDE_INT bitoffset;
4481 tree field, repr;
4483 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF);
4485 field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
4486 repr = DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE (field);
4487 /* If we do not have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE there is no
4488 need to limit the range we can access. */
4489 if (!repr)
4491 *bitstart = *bitend = 0;
4492 return;
4495 /* If we have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE but the enclosing record is
4496 part of a larger bit field, then the representative does not serve any
4497 useful purpose. This can occur in Ada. */
4498 if (handled_component_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
4500 enum machine_mode rmode;
4501 HOST_WIDE_INT rbitsize, rbitpos;
4502 tree roffset;
4503 int unsignedp;
4504 int volatilep = 0;
4505 get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), &rbitsize, &rbitpos,
4506 &roffset, &rmode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
4507 if ((rbitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) != 0)
4509 *bitstart = *bitend = 0;
4510 return;
4514 /* Compute the adjustment to bitpos from the offset of the field
4515 relative to the representative. DECL_FIELD_OFFSET of field and
4516 repr are the same by construction if they are not constants,
4517 see finish_bitfield_layout. */
4518 if (host_integerp (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), 1)
4519 && host_integerp (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (repr), 1))
4520 bitoffset = (tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), 1)
4521 - tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (repr), 1)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
4522 else
4523 bitoffset = 0;
4524 bitoffset += (tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field), 1)
4525 - tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (repr), 1));
4527 /* If the adjustment is larger than bitpos, we would have a negative bit
4528 position for the lower bound and this may wreak havoc later. This can
4529 occur only if we have a non-null offset, so adjust offset and bitpos
4530 to make the lower bound non-negative. */
4531 if (bitoffset > *bitpos)
4533 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust = bitoffset - *bitpos;
4535 gcc_assert ((adjust % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
4536 gcc_assert (*offset != NULL_TREE);
4538 *bitpos += adjust;
4539 *offset
4540 = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *offset, size_int (adjust / BITS_PER_UNIT));
4541 *bitstart = 0;
4543 else
4544 *bitstart = *bitpos - bitoffset;
4546 *bitend = *bitstart + tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (repr), 1) - 1;
4549 /* Returns true if the MEM_REF REF refers to an object that does not
4550 reside in memory and has non-BLKmode. */
4552 static bool
4553 mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (tree ref)
4555 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0);
4556 if (TREE_CODE (base) != ADDR_EXPR)
4557 return false;
4558 base = TREE_OPERAND (base, 0);
4559 return (DECL_P (base)
4560 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (base)
4561 && DECL_MODE (base) != BLKmode
4562 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (base)
4563 && !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (base)));
4566 /* Expand an assignment that stores the value of FROM into TO. If NONTEMPORAL
4567 is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
4569 void
4570 expand_assignment (tree to, tree from, bool nontemporal)
4572 rtx to_rtx = 0;
4573 rtx result;
4574 enum machine_mode mode;
4575 unsigned int align;
4576 enum insn_code icode;
4578 /* Don't crash if the lhs of the assignment was erroneous. */
4579 if (TREE_CODE (to) == ERROR_MARK)
4581 expand_normal (from);
4582 return;
4585 /* Optimize away no-op moves without side-effects. */
4586 if (operand_equal_p (to, from, 0))
4587 return;
4589 /* Handle misaligned stores. */
4590 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to));
4591 if ((TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
4592 || TREE_CODE (to) == TARGET_MEM_REF)
4593 && mode != BLKmode
4594 && !mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to)
4595 && ((align = get_object_alignment (to))
4596 < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
4597 && (((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
4598 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4599 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, align)))
4601 rtx reg, mem;
4603 reg = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4604 reg = force_not_mem (reg);
4605 mem = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4607 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4609 struct expand_operand ops[2];
4611 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], mem);
4612 create_input_operand (&ops[1], reg, mode);
4613 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
4614 would silently be omitted. */
4615 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
4617 else
4618 store_bit_field (mem, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
4619 0, 0, 0, mode, reg);
4620 return;
4623 /* Assignment of a structure component needs special treatment
4624 if the structure component's rtx is not simply a MEM.
4625 Assignment of an array element at a constant index, and assignment of
4626 an array element in an unaligned packed structure field, has the same
4627 problem. Same for (partially) storing into a non-memory object. */
4628 if (handled_component_p (to)
4629 || (TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
4630 && mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to))
4631 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4633 enum machine_mode mode1;
4634 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
4635 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start = 0;
4636 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end = 0;
4637 tree offset;
4638 int unsignedp;
4639 int volatilep = 0;
4640 tree tem;
4641 bool misalignp;
4642 rtx mem = NULL_RTX;
4644 push_temp_slots ();
4645 tem = get_inner_reference (to, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
4646 &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
4648 if (TREE_CODE (to) == COMPONENT_REF
4649 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (to, 1)))
4650 get_bit_range (&bitregion_start, &bitregion_end, to, &bitpos, &offset);
4652 /* If we are going to use store_bit_field and extract_bit_field,
4653 make sure to_rtx will be safe for multiple use. */
4654 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem));
4655 if (TREE_CODE (tem) == MEM_REF
4656 && mode != BLKmode
4657 && ((align = get_object_alignment (tem))
4658 < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
4659 && ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
4660 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
4662 struct expand_operand ops[2];
4664 misalignp = true;
4665 to_rtx = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
4666 mem = expand_expr (tem, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4668 /* If the misaligned store doesn't overwrite all bits, perform
4669 rmw cycle on MEM. */
4670 if (bitsize != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
4672 create_input_operand (&ops[0], to_rtx, mode);
4673 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], mem);
4674 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
4675 would silently be omitted. */
4676 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
4678 mem = copy_rtx (mem);
4681 else
4683 misalignp = false;
4684 to_rtx = expand_expr (tem, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4687 /* If the bitfield is volatile, we want to access it in the
4688 field's mode, not the computed mode.
4689 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
4690 use BLKmode for it instead. */
4691 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
4693 if (volatilep && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
4694 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, 0);
4695 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == VOIDmode)
4696 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, BLKmode, 0);
4699 if (offset != 0)
4701 enum machine_mode address_mode;
4702 rtx offset_rtx;
4704 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx))
4706 /* We can get constant negative offsets into arrays with broken
4707 user code. Translate this to a trap instead of ICEing. */
4708 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST);
4709 expand_builtin_trap ();
4710 to_rtx = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, const0_rtx);
4713 offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
4714 address_mode = get_address_mode (to_rtx);
4715 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
4716 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
4718 /* A constant address in TO_RTX can have VOIDmode, we must not try
4719 to call force_reg for that case. Avoid that case. */
4720 if (MEM_P (to_rtx)
4721 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode
4722 && GET_MODE (XEXP (to_rtx, 0)) != VOIDmode
4723 && bitsize > 0
4724 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
4725 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
4726 && MEM_ALIGN (to_rtx) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
4728 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4729 bitpos = 0;
4732 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
4733 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (to,
4734 offset));
4737 /* No action is needed if the target is not a memory and the field
4738 lies completely outside that target. This can occur if the source
4739 code contains an out-of-bounds access to a small array. */
4740 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx)
4741 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) != BLKmode
4742 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bitpos
4743 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (to_rtx)))
4745 expand_normal (from);
4746 result = NULL;
4748 /* Handle expand_expr of a complex value returning a CONCAT. */
4749 else if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == CONCAT)
4751 unsigned short mode_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx));
4752 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)))
4753 && bitpos == 0
4754 && bitsize == mode_bitsize)
4755 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, false, nontemporal);
4756 else if (bitsize == mode_bitsize / 2
4757 && (bitpos == 0 || bitpos == mode_bitsize / 2))
4758 result = store_expr (from, XEXP (to_rtx, bitpos != 0), false,
4759 nontemporal);
4760 else if (bitpos + bitsize <= mode_bitsize / 2)
4761 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), bitsize, bitpos,
4762 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4763 mode1, from, TREE_TYPE (tem),
4764 get_alias_set (to), nontemporal);
4765 else if (bitpos >= mode_bitsize / 2)
4766 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), bitsize,
4767 bitpos - mode_bitsize / 2,
4768 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4769 mode1, from,
4770 TREE_TYPE (tem), get_alias_set (to),
4771 nontemporal);
4772 else if (bitpos == 0 && bitsize == mode_bitsize)
4774 rtx from_rtx;
4775 result = expand_normal (from);
4776 from_rtx = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (to_rtx), result,
4777 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)), 0);
4778 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0),
4779 read_complex_part (from_rtx, false));
4780 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1),
4781 read_complex_part (from_rtx, true));
4783 else
4785 rtx temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (to_rtx),
4786 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx)));
4787 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), false);
4788 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 1), true);
4789 result = store_field (temp, bitsize, bitpos,
4790 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4791 mode1, from,
4792 TREE_TYPE (tem), get_alias_set (to),
4793 nontemporal);
4794 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), read_complex_part (temp, false));
4795 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), read_complex_part (temp, true));
4798 else
4800 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
4802 /* If the field is at offset zero, we could have been given the
4803 DECL_RTX of the parent struct. Don't munge it. */
4804 to_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (to_rtx);
4806 set_mem_attributes_minus_bitpos (to_rtx, to, 0, bitpos);
4808 /* Deal with volatile and readonly fields. The former is only
4809 done for MEM. Also set MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P if needed. */
4810 if (volatilep)
4811 MEM_VOLATILE_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4812 if (component_uses_parent_alias_set (to))
4813 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4816 if (optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (bitsize, bitpos,
4817 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4818 mode1,
4819 to_rtx, to, from))
4820 result = NULL;
4821 else
4822 result = store_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos,
4823 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4824 mode1, from,
4825 TREE_TYPE (tem), get_alias_set (to),
4826 nontemporal);
4829 if (misalignp)
4831 struct expand_operand ops[2];
4833 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], mem);
4834 create_input_operand (&ops[1], to_rtx, mode);
4835 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
4836 would silently be omitted. */
4837 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
4840 if (result)
4841 preserve_temp_slots (result);
4842 pop_temp_slots ();
4843 return;
4846 /* If the rhs is a function call and its value is not an aggregate,
4847 call the function before we start to compute the lhs.
4848 This is needed for correct code for cases such as
4849 val = setjmp (buf) on machines where reference to val
4850 requires loading up part of an address in a separate insn.
4852 Don't do this if TO is a VAR_DECL or PARM_DECL whose DECL_RTL is REG
4853 since it might be a promoted variable where the zero- or sign- extension
4854 needs to be done. Handling this in the normal way is safe because no
4855 computation is done before the call. The same is true for SSA names. */
4856 if (TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR && ! aggregate_value_p (from, from)
4857 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (from))
4858 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) == INTEGER_CST
4859 && ! (((TREE_CODE (to) == VAR_DECL
4860 || TREE_CODE (to) == PARM_DECL
4861 || TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL)
4862 && REG_P (DECL_RTL (to)))
4863 || TREE_CODE (to) == SSA_NAME))
4865 rtx value;
4867 push_temp_slots ();
4868 value = expand_normal (from);
4869 if (to_rtx == 0)
4870 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4872 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4873 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4874 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
4876 if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
4877 emit_group_move (to_rtx, value);
4878 else
4879 emit_group_load (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
4880 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4882 else if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
4883 emit_group_store (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
4884 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4885 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode)
4886 emit_block_move (to_rtx, value, expr_size (from), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
4887 else
4889 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (to)))
4890 value = convert_memory_address_addr_space
4891 (GET_MODE (to_rtx), value,
4892 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (to))));
4894 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, value);
4896 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4897 pop_temp_slots ();
4898 return;
4901 /* Ordinary treatment. Expand TO to get a REG or MEM rtx. */
4902 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4904 /* Don't move directly into a return register. */
4905 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
4906 && (REG_P (to_rtx) || GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL))
4908 rtx temp;
4910 push_temp_slots ();
4911 if (REG_P (to_rtx) && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) == BLKmode)
4912 temp = copy_blkmode_to_reg (GET_MODE (to_rtx), from);
4913 else
4914 temp = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (to_rtx), EXPAND_NORMAL);
4916 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4917 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4918 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
4920 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
4921 emit_group_move (to_rtx, temp);
4922 else
4923 emit_group_load (to_rtx, temp, TREE_TYPE (from),
4924 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4926 else if (temp)
4927 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
4929 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4930 pop_temp_slots ();
4931 return;
4934 /* In case we are returning the contents of an object which overlaps
4935 the place the value is being stored, use a safe function when copying
4936 a value through a pointer into a structure value return block. */
4937 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
4938 && TREE_CODE (from) == INDIRECT_REF
4939 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P
4940 (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (from, 0)))))
4941 && refs_may_alias_p (to, from)
4942 && cfun->returns_struct
4943 && !cfun->returns_pcc_struct)
4945 rtx from_rtx, size;
4947 push_temp_slots ();
4948 size = expr_size (from);
4949 from_rtx = expand_normal (from);
4951 emit_library_call (memmove_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
4952 VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
4953 XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
4954 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
4955 size, TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
4956 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
4958 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4959 pop_temp_slots ();
4960 return;
4963 /* Compute FROM and store the value in the rtx we got. */
4965 push_temp_slots ();
4966 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal);
4967 preserve_temp_slots (result);
4968 pop_temp_slots ();
4969 return;
4972 /* Emits nontemporal store insn that moves FROM to TO. Returns true if this
4973 succeeded, false otherwise. */
4975 bool
4976 emit_storent_insn (rtx to, rtx from)
4978 struct expand_operand ops[2];
4979 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (to);
4980 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (storent_optab, mode);
4982 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
4983 return false;
4985 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], to);
4986 create_input_operand (&ops[1], from, mode);
4987 return maybe_expand_insn (code, 2, ops);
4990 /* Generate code for computing expression EXP,
4991 and storing the value into TARGET.
4993 If the mode is BLKmode then we may return TARGET itself.
4994 It turns out that in BLKmode it doesn't cause a problem.
4995 because C has no operators that could combine two different
4996 assignments into the same BLKmode object with different values
4997 with no sequence point. Will other languages need this to
4998 be more thorough?
5000 If CALL_PARAM_P is nonzero, this is a store into a call param on the
5001 stack, and block moves may need to be treated specially.
5003 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try using a nontemporal store instruction. */
5006 store_expr (tree exp, rtx target, int call_param_p, bool nontemporal)
5008 rtx temp;
5009 rtx alt_rtl = NULL_RTX;
5010 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
5012 if (VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5014 /* C++ can generate ?: expressions with a throw expression in one
5015 branch and an rvalue in the other. Here, we resolve attempts to
5016 store the throw expression's nonexistent result. */
5017 gcc_assert (!call_param_p);
5018 expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
5019 return NULL_RTX;
5021 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_EXPR)
5023 /* Perform first part of compound expression, then assign from second
5024 part. */
5025 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
5026 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
5027 return store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p,
5028 nontemporal);
5030 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COND_EXPR && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
5032 /* For conditional expression, get safe form of the target. Then
5033 test the condition, doing the appropriate assignment on either
5034 side. This avoids the creation of unnecessary temporaries.
5035 For non-BLKmode, it is more efficient not to do this. */
5037 rtx lab1 = gen_label_rtx (), lab2 = gen_label_rtx ();
5039 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
5040 NO_DEFER_POP;
5041 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), lab1, -1);
5042 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p,
5043 nontemporal);
5044 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (lab2));
5045 emit_barrier ();
5046 emit_label (lab1);
5047 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), target, call_param_p,
5048 nontemporal);
5049 emit_label (lab2);
5050 OK_DEFER_POP;
5052 return NULL_RTX;
5054 else if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (target))
5055 /* If this is a scalar in a register that is stored in a wider mode
5056 than the declared mode, compute the result into its declared mode
5057 and then convert to the wider mode. Our value is the computed
5058 expression. */
5060 rtx inner_target = 0;
5062 /* We can do the conversion inside EXP, which will often result
5063 in some optimizations. Do the conversion in two steps: first
5064 change the signedness, if needed, then the extend. But don't
5065 do this if the type of EXP is a subtype of something else
5066 since then the conversion might involve more than just
5067 converting modes. */
5068 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5069 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == 0
5070 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (target))
5071 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5073 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5074 != SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target))
5076 /* Some types, e.g. Fortran's logical*4, won't have a signed
5077 version, so use the mode instead. */
5078 tree ntype
5079 = (signed_or_unsigned_type_for
5080 (SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target), TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5081 if (ntype == NULL)
5082 ntype = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5083 (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5084 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5086 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, ntype, exp);
5089 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5090 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
5091 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target)),
5092 exp);
5094 inner_target = SUBREG_REG (target);
5097 temp = expand_expr (exp, inner_target, VOIDmode,
5098 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
5100 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant, use convert_modes to make
5101 sure that we properly convert it. */
5102 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
5104 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5105 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5106 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
5107 GET_MODE (target), temp,
5108 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5111 convert_move (SUBREG_REG (target), temp,
5112 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5114 return NULL_RTX;
5116 else if ((TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
5117 || (TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
5118 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
5119 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
5120 == STRING_CST
5121 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
5122 && !nontemporal && !call_param_p
5123 && MEM_P (target))
5125 /* Optimize initialization of an array with a STRING_CST. */
5126 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_len, str_copy_len;
5127 rtx dest_mem;
5128 tree str = TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
5129 ? exp : TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
5131 exp_len = int_expr_size (exp);
5132 if (exp_len <= 0)
5133 goto normal_expr;
5135 if (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) <= 0)
5136 goto normal_expr;
5138 str_copy_len = strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (str));
5139 if (str_copy_len < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) - 1)
5140 goto normal_expr;
5142 str_copy_len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str);
5143 if ((STORE_MAX_PIECES & (STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1)) == 0
5144 && TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)[TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) - 1] == '\0')
5146 str_copy_len += STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1;
5147 str_copy_len &= ~(STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1);
5149 str_copy_len = MIN (str_copy_len, exp_len);
5150 if (!can_store_by_pieces (str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
5151 CONST_CAST (char *, TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)),
5152 MEM_ALIGN (target), false))
5153 goto normal_expr;
5155 dest_mem = target;
5157 dest_mem = store_by_pieces (dest_mem,
5158 str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
5159 CONST_CAST (char *,
5160 TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)),
5161 MEM_ALIGN (target), false,
5162 exp_len > str_copy_len ? 1 : 0);
5163 if (exp_len > str_copy_len)
5164 clear_storage (adjust_address (dest_mem, BLKmode, 0),
5165 GEN_INT (exp_len - str_copy_len),
5166 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5167 return NULL_RTX;
5169 else
5171 rtx tmp_target;
5173 normal_expr:
5174 /* If we want to use a nontemporal store, force the value to
5175 register first. */
5176 tmp_target = nontemporal ? NULL_RTX : target;
5177 temp = expand_expr_real (exp, tmp_target, GET_MODE (target),
5178 (call_param_p
5179 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL),
5180 &alt_rtl);
5183 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant and the mode of the type of EXP is not
5184 the same as that of TARGET, adjust the constant. This is needed, for
5185 example, in case it is a CONST_DOUBLE and we want only a word-sized
5186 value. */
5187 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode
5188 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
5189 && GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5190 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5191 temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5193 /* If value was not generated in the target, store it there.
5194 Convert the value to TARGET's type first if necessary and emit the
5195 pending incrementations that have been queued when expanding EXP.
5196 Note that we cannot emit the whole queue blindly because this will
5197 effectively disable the POST_INC optimization later.
5199 If TEMP and TARGET compare equal according to rtx_equal_p, but
5200 one or both of them are volatile memory refs, we have to distinguish
5201 two cases:
5202 - expand_expr has used TARGET. In this case, we must not generate
5203 another copy. This can be detected by TARGET being equal according
5204 to == .
5205 - expand_expr has not used TARGET - that means that the source just
5206 happens to have the same RTX form. Since temp will have been created
5207 by expand_expr, it will compare unequal according to == .
5208 We must generate a copy in this case, to reach the correct number
5209 of volatile memory references. */
5211 if ((! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
5212 || (temp != target && (side_effects_p (temp)
5213 || side_effects_p (target))))
5214 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
5215 /* If store_expr stores a DECL whose DECL_RTL(exp) == TARGET,
5216 but TARGET is not valid memory reference, TEMP will differ
5217 from TARGET although it is really the same location. */
5218 && !(alt_rtl
5219 && rtx_equal_p (alt_rtl, target)
5220 && !side_effects_p (alt_rtl)
5221 && !side_effects_p (target))
5222 /* If there's nothing to copy, don't bother. Don't call
5223 expr_size unless necessary, because some front-ends (C++)
5224 expr_size-hook must not be given objects that are not
5225 supposed to be bit-copied or bit-initialized. */
5226 && expr_size (exp) != const0_rtx)
5228 if (GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target)
5229 && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
5231 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
5232 if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
5233 && GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
5234 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
5235 (call_param_p
5236 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM
5237 : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5238 else if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
5239 store_bit_field (target, INTVAL (expr_size (exp)) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
5240 0, 0, 0, GET_MODE (temp), temp);
5241 else
5242 convert_move (target, temp, unsignedp);
5245 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
5247 /* Handle copying a string constant into an array. The string
5248 constant may be shorter than the array. So copy just the string's
5249 actual length, and clear the rest. First get the size of the data
5250 type of the string, which is actually the size of the target. */
5251 rtx size = expr_size (exp);
5253 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
5254 && INTVAL (size) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp))
5255 emit_block_move (target, temp, size,
5256 (call_param_p
5257 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5258 else
5260 enum machine_mode pointer_mode
5261 = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (target));
5262 enum machine_mode address_mode = get_address_mode (target);
5264 /* Compute the size of the data to copy from the string. */
5265 tree copy_size
5266 = size_binop_loc (loc, MIN_EXPR,
5267 make_tree (sizetype, size),
5268 size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp)));
5269 rtx copy_size_rtx
5270 = expand_expr (copy_size, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
5271 (call_param_p
5272 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
5273 rtx label = 0;
5275 /* Copy that much. */
5276 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (pointer_mode, copy_size_rtx,
5277 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
5278 emit_block_move (target, temp, copy_size_rtx,
5279 (call_param_p
5280 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5282 /* Figure out how much is left in TARGET that we have to clear.
5283 Do all calculations in pointer_mode. */
5284 if (CONST_INT_P (copy_size_rtx))
5286 size = plus_constant (address_mode, size,
5287 -INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
5288 target = adjust_address (target, BLKmode,
5289 INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
5291 else
5293 size = expand_binop (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), sub_optab, size,
5294 copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
5295 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5297 if (GET_MODE (copy_size_rtx) != address_mode)
5298 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode,
5299 copy_size_rtx,
5300 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
5302 target = offset_address (target, copy_size_rtx,
5303 highest_pow2_factor (copy_size));
5304 label = gen_label_rtx ();
5305 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (size, const0_rtx, LT, NULL_RTX,
5306 GET_MODE (size), 0, label);
5309 if (size != const0_rtx)
5310 clear_storage (target, size, BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5312 if (label)
5313 emit_label (label);
5316 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
5317 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
5318 else if (GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
5320 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
5321 emit_group_move (target, temp);
5322 else
5323 emit_group_load (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
5324 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5326 else if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
5327 emit_group_store (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
5328 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5329 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
5330 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
5331 (call_param_p
5332 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5333 /* If we emit a nontemporal store, there is nothing else to do. */
5334 else if (nontemporal && emit_storent_insn (target, temp))
5336 else
5338 temp = force_operand (temp, target);
5339 if (temp != target)
5340 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
5344 return NULL_RTX;
5347 /* Return true if field F of structure TYPE is a flexible array. */
5349 static bool
5350 flexible_array_member_p (const_tree f, const_tree type)
5352 const_tree tf;
5354 tf = TREE_TYPE (f);
5355 return (DECL_CHAIN (f) == NULL
5356 && TREE_CODE (tf) == ARRAY_TYPE
5357 && TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)
5358 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5359 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)))
5360 && !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5361 && int_size_in_bytes (type) >= 0);
5364 /* If FOR_CTOR_P, return the number of top-level elements that a constructor
5365 must have in order for it to completely initialize a value of type TYPE.
5366 Return -1 if the number isn't known.
5368 If !FOR_CTOR_P, return an estimate of the number of scalars in TYPE. */
5370 static HOST_WIDE_INT
5371 count_type_elements (const_tree type, bool for_ctor_p)
5373 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
5375 case ARRAY_TYPE:
5377 tree nelts;
5379 nelts = array_type_nelts (type);
5380 if (nelts && host_integerp (nelts, 1))
5382 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
5384 n = tree_low_cst (nelts, 1) + 1;
5385 if (n == 0 || for_ctor_p)
5386 return n;
5387 else
5388 return n * count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (type), false);
5390 return for_ctor_p ? -1 : 1;
5393 case RECORD_TYPE:
5395 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
5396 tree f;
5398 n = 0;
5399 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
5400 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
5402 if (!for_ctor_p)
5403 n += count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
5404 else if (!flexible_array_member_p (f, type))
5405 /* Don't count flexible arrays, which are not supposed
5406 to be initialized. */
5407 n += 1;
5410 return n;
5413 case UNION_TYPE:
5414 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
5416 tree f;
5417 HOST_WIDE_INT n, m;
5419 gcc_assert (!for_ctor_p);
5420 /* Estimate the number of scalars in each field and pick the
5421 maximum. Other estimates would do instead; the idea is simply
5422 to make sure that the estimate is not sensitive to the ordering
5423 of the fields. */
5424 n = 1;
5425 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
5426 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
5428 m = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
5429 /* If the field doesn't span the whole union, add an extra
5430 scalar for the rest. */
5431 if (simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (f)),
5432 TYPE_SIZE (type)) != 1)
5433 m++;
5434 if (n < m)
5435 n = m;
5437 return n;
5440 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
5441 return 2;
5443 case VECTOR_TYPE:
5444 return TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
5446 case INTEGER_TYPE:
5447 case REAL_TYPE:
5448 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
5449 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
5450 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
5451 case POINTER_TYPE:
5452 case OFFSET_TYPE:
5453 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
5454 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
5455 return 1;
5457 case ERROR_MARK:
5458 return 0;
5460 case VOID_TYPE:
5461 case METHOD_TYPE:
5462 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
5463 case LANG_TYPE:
5464 default:
5465 gcc_unreachable ();
5469 /* Helper for categorize_ctor_elements. Identical interface. */
5471 static bool
5472 categorize_ctor_elements_1 (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
5473 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
5475 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5476 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts, num_fields;
5477 tree value, purpose, elt_type;
5479 /* Whether CTOR is a valid constant initializer, in accordance with what
5480 initializer_constant_valid_p does. If inferred from the constructor
5481 elements, true until proven otherwise. */
5482 bool const_from_elts_p = constructor_static_from_elts_p (ctor);
5483 bool const_p = const_from_elts_p ? true : TREE_STATIC (ctor);
5485 nz_elts = 0;
5486 init_elts = 0;
5487 num_fields = 0;
5488 elt_type = NULL_TREE;
5490 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor), idx, purpose, value)
5492 HOST_WIDE_INT mult = 1;
5494 if (TREE_CODE (purpose) == RANGE_EXPR)
5496 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 0);
5497 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 1);
5499 if (host_integerp (lo_index, 1) && host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
5500 mult = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
5501 - tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
5503 num_fields += mult;
5504 elt_type = TREE_TYPE (value);
5506 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
5508 case CONSTRUCTOR:
5510 HOST_WIDE_INT nz = 0, ic = 0;
5512 bool const_elt_p = categorize_ctor_elements_1 (value, &nz, &ic,
5513 p_complete);
5515 nz_elts += mult * nz;
5516 init_elts += mult * ic;
5518 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
5519 const_p = const_elt_p;
5521 break;
5523 case INTEGER_CST:
5524 case REAL_CST:
5525 case FIXED_CST:
5526 if (!initializer_zerop (value))
5527 nz_elts += mult;
5528 init_elts += mult;
5529 break;
5531 case STRING_CST:
5532 nz_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
5533 init_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
5534 break;
5536 case COMPLEX_CST:
5537 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_REALPART (value)))
5538 nz_elts += mult;
5539 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_IMAGPART (value)))
5540 nz_elts += mult;
5541 init_elts += mult;
5542 break;
5544 case VECTOR_CST:
5546 unsigned i;
5547 for (i = 0; i < VECTOR_CST_NELTS (value); ++i)
5549 tree v = VECTOR_CST_ELT (value, i);
5550 if (!initializer_zerop (v))
5551 nz_elts += mult;
5552 init_elts += mult;
5555 break;
5557 default:
5559 HOST_WIDE_INT tc = count_type_elements (elt_type, false);
5560 nz_elts += mult * tc;
5561 init_elts += mult * tc;
5563 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
5564 const_p = initializer_constant_valid_p (value, elt_type)
5565 != NULL_TREE;
5567 break;
5571 if (*p_complete && !complete_ctor_at_level_p (TREE_TYPE (ctor),
5572 num_fields, elt_type))
5573 *p_complete = false;
5575 *p_nz_elts += nz_elts;
5576 *p_init_elts += init_elts;
5578 return const_p;
5581 /* Examine CTOR to discover:
5582 * how many scalar fields are set to nonzero values,
5583 and place it in *P_NZ_ELTS;
5584 * how many scalar fields in total are in CTOR,
5585 and place it in *P_ELT_COUNT.
5586 * whether the constructor is complete -- in the sense that every
5587 meaningful byte is explicitly given a value --
5588 and place it in *P_COMPLETE.
5590 Return whether or not CTOR is a valid static constant initializer, the same
5591 as "initializer_constant_valid_p (CTOR, TREE_TYPE (CTOR)) != 0". */
5593 bool
5594 categorize_ctor_elements (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
5595 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
5597 *p_nz_elts = 0;
5598 *p_init_elts = 0;
5599 *p_complete = true;
5601 return categorize_ctor_elements_1 (ctor, p_nz_elts, p_init_elts, p_complete);
5604 /* TYPE is initialized by a constructor with NUM_ELTS elements, the last
5605 of which had type LAST_TYPE. Each element was itself a complete
5606 initializer, in the sense that every meaningful byte was explicitly
5607 given a value. Return true if the same is true for the constructor
5608 as a whole. */
5610 bool
5611 complete_ctor_at_level_p (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT num_elts,
5612 const_tree last_type)
5614 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
5615 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
5617 if (num_elts == 0)
5618 return false;
5620 gcc_assert (num_elts == 1 && last_type);
5622 /* ??? We could look at each element of the union, and find the
5623 largest element. Which would avoid comparing the size of the
5624 initialized element against any tail padding in the union.
5625 Doesn't seem worth the effort... */
5626 return simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (type), TYPE_SIZE (last_type)) == 1;
5629 return count_type_elements (type, true) == num_elts;
5632 /* Return 1 if EXP contains mostly (3/4) zeros. */
5634 static int
5635 mostly_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
5637 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5639 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts;
5640 bool complete_p;
5642 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &init_elts, &complete_p);
5643 return !complete_p || nz_elts < init_elts / 4;
5646 return initializer_zerop (exp);
5649 /* Return 1 if EXP contains all zeros. */
5651 static int
5652 all_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
5654 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5656 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts;
5657 bool complete_p;
5659 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &init_elts, &complete_p);
5660 return nz_elts == 0;
5663 return initializer_zerop (exp);
5666 /* Helper function for store_constructor.
5667 TARGET, BITSIZE, BITPOS, MODE, EXP are as for store_field.
5668 TYPE is the type of the CONSTRUCTOR, not the element type.
5669 CLEARED is as for store_constructor.
5670 ALIAS_SET is the alias set to use for any stores.
5672 This provides a recursive shortcut back to store_constructor when it isn't
5673 necessary to go through store_field. This is so that we can pass through
5674 the cleared field to let store_constructor know that we may not have to
5675 clear a substructure if the outer structure has already been cleared. */
5677 static void
5678 store_constructor_field (rtx target, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
5679 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, enum machine_mode mode,
5680 tree exp, tree type, int cleared,
5681 alias_set_type alias_set)
5683 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
5684 /* We can only call store_constructor recursively if the size and
5685 bit position are on a byte boundary. */
5686 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
5687 && (bitsize > 0 && bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0)
5688 /* If we have a nonzero bitpos for a register target, then we just
5689 let store_field do the bitfield handling. This is unlikely to
5690 generate unnecessary clear instructions anyways. */
5691 && (bitpos == 0 || MEM_P (target)))
5693 if (MEM_P (target))
5694 target
5695 = adjust_address (target,
5696 GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
5697 || 0 != (bitpos
5698 % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (GET_MODE (target)))
5699 ? BLKmode : VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5702 /* Update the alias set, if required. */
5703 if (MEM_P (target) && ! MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
5704 && MEM_ALIAS_SET (target) != 0)
5706 target = copy_rtx (target);
5707 set_mem_alias_set (target, alias_set);
5710 store_constructor (exp, target, cleared, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5712 else
5713 store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, 0, 0, mode, exp, type, alias_set,
5714 false);
5717 /* Store the value of constructor EXP into the rtx TARGET.
5718 TARGET is either a REG or a MEM; we know it cannot conflict, since
5719 safe_from_p has been called.
5720 CLEARED is true if TARGET is known to have been zero'd.
5721 SIZE is the number of bytes of TARGET we are allowed to modify: this
5722 may not be the same as the size of EXP if we are assigning to a field
5723 which has been packed to exclude padding bits. */
5725 static void
5726 store_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, int cleared, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
5728 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
5729 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
5730 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
5731 #endif
5733 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
5735 case RECORD_TYPE:
5736 case UNION_TYPE:
5737 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
5739 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5740 tree field, value;
5742 /* If size is zero or the target is already cleared, do nothing. */
5743 if (size == 0 || cleared)
5744 cleared = 1;
5745 /* We either clear the aggregate or indicate the value is dead. */
5746 else if ((TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
5747 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
5748 && ! CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
5749 /* If the constructor is empty, clear the union. */
5751 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5752 cleared = 1;
5755 /* If we are building a static constructor into a register,
5756 set the initial value as zero so we can fold the value into
5757 a constant. But if more than one register is involved,
5758 this probably loses. */
5759 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp)
5760 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
5762 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
5763 cleared = 1;
5766 /* If the constructor has fewer fields than the structure or
5767 if we are initializing the structure to mostly zeros, clear
5768 the whole structure first. Don't do this if TARGET is a
5769 register whose mode size isn't equal to SIZE since
5770 clear_storage can't handle this case. */
5771 else if (size > 0
5772 && (((int)VEC_length (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
5773 != fields_length (type))
5774 || mostly_zeros_p (exp))
5775 && (!REG_P (target)
5776 || ((HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target))
5777 == size)))
5779 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5780 cleared = 1;
5783 if (REG_P (target) && !cleared)
5784 emit_clobber (target);
5786 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
5787 corresponding field of TARGET. */
5788 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, field, value)
5790 enum machine_mode mode;
5791 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
5792 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos = 0;
5793 tree offset;
5794 rtx to_rtx = target;
5796 /* Just ignore missing fields. We cleared the whole
5797 structure, above, if any fields are missing. */
5798 if (field == 0)
5799 continue;
5801 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
5802 continue;
5804 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (field), 1))
5805 bitsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (field), 1);
5806 else
5807 bitsize = -1;
5809 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
5810 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
5811 mode = VOIDmode;
5813 offset = DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field);
5814 if (host_integerp (offset, 0)
5815 && host_integerp (bit_position (field), 0))
5817 bitpos = int_bit_position (field);
5818 offset = 0;
5820 else
5821 bitpos = tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field), 0);
5823 if (offset)
5825 enum machine_mode address_mode;
5826 rtx offset_rtx;
5828 offset
5829 = SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (offset,
5830 make_tree (TREE_TYPE (exp),
5831 target));
5833 offset_rtx = expand_normal (offset);
5834 gcc_assert (MEM_P (to_rtx));
5836 address_mode = get_address_mode (to_rtx);
5837 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
5838 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
5840 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
5841 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
5844 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
5845 /* If this initializes a field that is smaller than a
5846 word, at the start of a word, try to widen it to a full
5847 word. This special case allows us to output C++ member
5848 function initializations in a form that the optimizers
5849 can understand. */
5850 if (REG_P (target)
5851 && bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
5852 && bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
5853 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5854 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST
5855 && exp_size >= 0
5856 && bitpos + BITS_PER_WORD <= exp_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
5858 tree type = TREE_TYPE (value);
5860 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) < BITS_PER_WORD)
5862 type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5863 (word_mode, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
5864 value = fold_convert (type, value);
5867 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
5868 value
5869 = fold_build2 (LSHIFT_EXPR, type, value,
5870 build_int_cst (type,
5871 BITS_PER_WORD - bitsize));
5872 bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
5873 mode = word_mode;
5875 #endif
5877 if (MEM_P (to_rtx) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx)
5878 && DECL_NONADDRESSABLE_P (field))
5880 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
5881 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
5884 store_constructor_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode,
5885 value, type, cleared,
5886 get_alias_set (TREE_TYPE (field)));
5888 break;
5890 case ARRAY_TYPE:
5892 tree value, index;
5893 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i;
5894 int need_to_clear;
5895 tree domain;
5896 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
5897 int const_bounds_p;
5898 HOST_WIDE_INT minelt = 0;
5899 HOST_WIDE_INT maxelt = 0;
5901 domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
5902 const_bounds_p = (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)
5903 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
5904 && host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0)
5905 && host_integerp (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0));
5907 /* If we have constant bounds for the range of the type, get them. */
5908 if (const_bounds_p)
5910 minelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0);
5911 maxelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0);
5914 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the array, clear
5915 the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
5916 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
5917 if (cleared)
5918 need_to_clear = 0;
5919 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
5920 need_to_clear = 1;
5921 else
5923 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5924 tree index, value;
5925 HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
5926 need_to_clear = ! const_bounds_p;
5928 /* This loop is a more accurate version of the loop in
5929 mostly_zeros_p (it handles RANGE_EXPR in an index). It
5930 is also needed to check for missing elements. */
5931 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, index, value)
5933 HOST_WIDE_INT this_node_count;
5935 if (need_to_clear)
5936 break;
5938 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
5940 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
5941 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
5943 if (! host_integerp (lo_index, 1)
5944 || ! host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
5946 need_to_clear = 1;
5947 break;
5950 this_node_count = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
5951 - tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
5953 else
5954 this_node_count = 1;
5956 count += this_node_count;
5957 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
5958 zero_count += this_node_count;
5961 /* Clear the entire array first if there are any missing
5962 elements, or if the incidence of zero elements is >=
5963 75%. */
5964 if (! need_to_clear
5965 && (count < maxelt - minelt + 1
5966 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count))
5967 need_to_clear = 1;
5970 if (need_to_clear && size > 0)
5972 if (REG_P (target))
5973 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
5974 else
5975 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5976 cleared = 1;
5979 if (!cleared && REG_P (target))
5980 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
5981 emit_clobber (target);
5983 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
5984 corresponding element of TARGET, determined by counting the
5985 elements. */
5986 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i, index, value)
5988 enum machine_mode mode;
5989 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
5990 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
5991 rtx xtarget = target;
5993 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
5994 continue;
5996 mode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
5997 if (mode == BLKmode)
5998 bitsize = (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
5999 ? tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
6000 : -1);
6001 else
6002 bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
6004 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
6006 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
6007 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
6008 rtx index_r, pos_rtx;
6009 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi, count;
6010 tree position;
6012 /* If the range is constant and "small", unroll the loop. */
6013 if (const_bounds_p
6014 && host_integerp (lo_index, 0)
6015 && host_integerp (hi_index, 0)
6016 && (lo = tree_low_cst (lo_index, 0),
6017 hi = tree_low_cst (hi_index, 0),
6018 count = hi - lo + 1,
6019 (!MEM_P (target)
6020 || count <= 2
6021 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
6022 && (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1) * count
6023 <= 40 * 8)))))
6025 lo -= minelt; hi -= minelt;
6026 for (; lo <= hi; lo++)
6028 bitpos = lo * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 0);
6030 if (MEM_P (target)
6031 && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
6032 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
6033 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
6035 target = copy_rtx (target);
6036 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
6039 store_constructor_field
6040 (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value, type, cleared,
6041 get_alias_set (elttype));
6044 else
6046 rtx loop_start = gen_label_rtx ();
6047 rtx loop_end = gen_label_rtx ();
6048 tree exit_cond;
6050 expand_normal (hi_index);
6052 index = build_decl (EXPR_LOCATION (exp),
6053 VAR_DECL, NULL_TREE, domain);
6054 index_r = gen_reg_rtx (promote_decl_mode (index, NULL));
6055 SET_DECL_RTL (index, index_r);
6056 store_expr (lo_index, index_r, 0, false);
6058 /* Build the head of the loop. */
6059 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
6060 emit_label (loop_start);
6062 /* Assign value to element index. */
6063 position =
6064 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6065 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
6066 TREE_TYPE (index),
6067 index,
6068 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
6070 position =
6071 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, position,
6072 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6073 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
6075 pos_rtx = expand_normal (position);
6076 xtarget = offset_address (target, pos_rtx,
6077 highest_pow2_factor (position));
6078 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
6079 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
6080 store_constructor (value, xtarget, cleared,
6081 bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6082 else
6083 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false);
6085 /* Generate a conditional jump to exit the loop. */
6086 exit_cond = build2 (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
6087 index, hi_index);
6088 jumpif (exit_cond, loop_end, -1);
6090 /* Update the loop counter, and jump to the head of
6091 the loop. */
6092 expand_assignment (index,
6093 build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
6094 index, integer_one_node),
6095 false);
6097 emit_jump (loop_start);
6099 /* Build the end of the loop. */
6100 emit_label (loop_end);
6103 else if ((index != 0 && ! host_integerp (index, 0))
6104 || ! host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1))
6106 tree position;
6108 if (index == 0)
6109 index = ssize_int (1);
6111 if (minelt)
6112 index = fold_convert (ssizetype,
6113 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
6114 TREE_TYPE (index),
6115 index,
6116 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
6118 position =
6119 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, index,
6120 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6121 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
6122 xtarget = offset_address (target,
6123 expand_normal (position),
6124 highest_pow2_factor (position));
6125 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
6126 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false);
6128 else
6130 if (index != 0)
6131 bitpos = ((tree_low_cst (index, 0) - minelt)
6132 * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
6133 else
6134 bitpos = (i * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
6136 if (MEM_P (target) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
6137 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
6138 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
6140 target = copy_rtx (target);
6141 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
6143 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value,
6144 type, cleared, get_alias_set (elttype));
6147 break;
6150 case VECTOR_TYPE:
6152 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
6153 constructor_elt *ce;
6154 int i;
6155 int need_to_clear;
6156 int icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6157 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
6158 int elt_size = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1);
6159 enum machine_mode eltmode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
6160 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
6161 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
6162 rtvec vector = NULL;
6163 unsigned n_elts;
6164 alias_set_type alias;
6166 gcc_assert (eltmode != BLKmode);
6168 n_elts = TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
6169 if (REG_P (target) && VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (target)))
6171 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (target);
6173 icode = (int) optab_handler (vec_init_optab, mode);
6174 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6176 unsigned int i;
6178 vector = rtvec_alloc (n_elts);
6179 for (i = 0; i < n_elts; i++)
6180 RTVEC_ELT (vector, i) = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
6184 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the vector,
6185 clear the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
6186 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
6187 if (cleared)
6188 need_to_clear = 0;
6189 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
6190 need_to_clear = 1;
6191 else
6193 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
6194 tree value;
6196 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
6198 int n_elts_here = tree_low_cst
6199 (int_const_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
6200 TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)),
6201 TYPE_SIZE (elttype)), 1);
6203 count += n_elts_here;
6204 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
6205 zero_count += n_elts_here;
6208 /* Clear the entire vector first if there are any missing elements,
6209 or if the incidence of zero elements is >= 75%. */
6210 need_to_clear = (count < n_elts || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count);
6213 if (need_to_clear && size > 0 && !vector)
6215 if (REG_P (target))
6216 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6217 else
6218 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6219 cleared = 1;
6222 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
6223 if (!cleared && !vector && REG_P (target))
6224 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6226 if (MEM_P (target))
6227 alias = MEM_ALIAS_SET (target);
6228 else
6229 alias = get_alias_set (elttype);
6231 /* Store each element of the constructor into the corresponding
6232 element of TARGET, determined by counting the elements. */
6233 for (idx = 0, i = 0;
6234 VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce);
6235 idx++, i += bitsize / elt_size)
6237 HOST_WIDE_INT eltpos;
6238 tree value = ce->value;
6240 bitsize = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)), 1);
6241 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
6242 continue;
6244 if (ce->index)
6245 eltpos = tree_low_cst (ce->index, 1);
6246 else
6247 eltpos = i;
6249 if (vector)
6251 /* Vector CONSTRUCTORs should only be built from smaller
6252 vectors in the case of BLKmode vectors. */
6253 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) != VECTOR_TYPE);
6254 RTVEC_ELT (vector, eltpos)
6255 = expand_normal (value);
6257 else
6259 enum machine_mode value_mode =
6260 TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE
6261 ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (value))
6262 : eltmode;
6263 bitpos = eltpos * elt_size;
6264 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
6265 value_mode, value, type,
6266 cleared, alias);
6270 if (vector)
6271 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode)
6272 (target,
6273 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (target), vector)));
6274 break;
6277 default:
6278 gcc_unreachable ();
6282 /* Store the value of EXP (an expression tree)
6283 into a subfield of TARGET which has mode MODE and occupies
6284 BITSIZE bits, starting BITPOS bits from the start of TARGET.
6285 If MODE is VOIDmode, it means that we are storing into a bit-field.
6287 BITREGION_START is bitpos of the first bitfield in this region.
6288 BITREGION_END is the bitpos of the ending bitfield in this region.
6289 These two fields are 0, if the C++ memory model does not apply,
6290 or we are not interested in keeping track of bitfield regions.
6292 Always return const0_rtx unless we have something particular to
6293 return.
6295 TYPE is the type of the underlying object,
6297 ALIAS_SET is the alias set for the destination. This value will
6298 (in general) be different from that for TARGET, since TARGET is a
6299 reference to the containing structure.
6301 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
6303 static rtx
6304 store_field (rtx target, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
6305 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start,
6306 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end,
6307 enum machine_mode mode, tree exp, tree type,
6308 alias_set_type alias_set, bool nontemporal)
6310 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
6311 return const0_rtx;
6313 /* If we have nothing to store, do nothing unless the expression has
6314 side-effects. */
6315 if (bitsize == 0)
6316 return expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6318 /* If we are storing into an unaligned field of an aligned union that is
6319 in a register, we may have the mode of TARGET being an integer mode but
6320 MODE == BLKmode. In that case, get an aligned object whose size and
6321 alignment are the same as TARGET and store TARGET into it (we can avoid
6322 the store if the field being stored is the entire width of TARGET). Then
6323 call ourselves recursively to store the field into a BLKmode version of
6324 that object. Finally, load from the object into TARGET. This is not
6325 very efficient in general, but should only be slightly more expensive
6326 than the otherwise-required unaligned accesses. Perhaps this can be
6327 cleaned up later. It's tempting to make OBJECT readonly, but it's set
6328 twice, once with emit_move_insn and once via store_field. */
6330 if (mode == BLKmode
6331 && (REG_P (target) || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG))
6333 rtx object = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
6334 rtx blk_object = adjust_address (object, BLKmode, 0);
6336 if (bitsize != (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (target)))
6337 emit_move_insn (object, target);
6339 store_field (blk_object, bitsize, bitpos,
6340 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6341 mode, exp, type, MEM_ALIAS_SET (blk_object), nontemporal);
6343 emit_move_insn (target, object);
6345 /* We want to return the BLKmode version of the data. */
6346 return blk_object;
6349 if (GET_CODE (target) == CONCAT)
6351 /* We're storing into a struct containing a single __complex. */
6353 gcc_assert (!bitpos);
6354 return store_expr (exp, target, 0, nontemporal);
6357 /* If the structure is in a register or if the component
6358 is a bit field, we cannot use addressing to access it.
6359 Use bit-field techniques or SUBREG to store in it. */
6361 if (mode == VOIDmode
6362 || (mode != BLKmode && ! direct_store[(int) mode]
6363 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
6364 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
6365 || REG_P (target)
6366 || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG
6367 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to store as an ordinary memref,
6368 store it as a bit field. */
6369 || (mode != BLKmode
6370 && ((((MEM_ALIGN (target) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
6371 || bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
6372 && SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target)))
6373 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
6374 || (bitsize >= 0 && mode != BLKmode
6375 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) > bitsize)
6376 /* If the RHS and field are a constant size and the size of the
6377 RHS isn't the same size as the bitfield, we must use bitfield
6378 operations. */
6379 || (bitsize >= 0
6380 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
6381 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) != 0)
6382 /* If we are expanding a MEM_REF of a non-BLKmode non-addressable
6383 decl we must use bitfield operations. */
6384 || (bitsize >= 0
6385 && TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
6386 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
6387 && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
6388 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),0 ))
6389 && DECL_MODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)) != BLKmode))
6391 rtx temp;
6392 gimple nop_def;
6394 /* If EXP is a NOP_EXPR of precision less than its mode, then that
6395 implies a mask operation. If the precision is the same size as
6396 the field we're storing into, that mask is redundant. This is
6397 particularly common with bit field assignments generated by the
6398 C front end. */
6399 nop_def = get_def_for_expr (exp, NOP_EXPR);
6400 if (nop_def)
6402 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
6403 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
6404 && TYPE_PRECISION (type) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (type))
6405 && bitsize == TYPE_PRECISION (type))
6407 tree op = gimple_assign_rhs1 (nop_def);
6408 type = TREE_TYPE (op);
6409 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && TYPE_PRECISION (type) >= bitsize)
6410 exp = op;
6414 temp = expand_normal (exp);
6416 /* If BITSIZE is narrower than the size of the type of EXP
6417 we will be narrowing TEMP. Normally, what's wanted are the
6418 low-order bits. However, if EXP's type is a record and this is
6419 big-endian machine, we want the upper BITSIZE bits. */
6420 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (temp)) == MODE_INT
6421 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
6422 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == RECORD_TYPE)
6423 temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (temp), temp,
6424 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp)) - bitsize,
6425 NULL_RTX, 1);
6427 /* Unless MODE is VOIDmode or BLKmode, convert TEMP to MODE. */
6428 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
6429 && mode != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
6430 temp = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp, 1);
6432 /* If the modes of TEMP and TARGET are both BLKmode, both
6433 must be in memory and BITPOS must be aligned on a byte
6434 boundary. If so, we simply do a block copy. Likewise
6435 for a BLKmode-like TARGET. */
6436 if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode
6437 && (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
6438 || (MEM_P (target)
6439 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (target)) == MODE_INT
6440 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
6441 && (bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0)))
6443 gcc_assert (MEM_P (target) && MEM_P (temp)
6444 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
6446 target = adjust_address (target, VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6447 emit_block_move (target, temp,
6448 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
6449 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
6450 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6452 return const0_rtx;
6455 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
6456 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
6457 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
6459 rtx temp_target;
6461 /* We are not supposed to have a true bitfield in this case. */
6462 gcc_assert (bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode));
6464 /* If we don't store at bit 0, we need an intermediate pseudo
6465 since emit_group_store only stores at bit 0. */
6466 if (bitpos != 0)
6467 temp_target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
6468 else
6469 temp_target = target;
6471 emit_group_store (temp_target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
6472 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6474 if (temp_target == target)
6475 return const0_rtx;
6477 temp = temp_target;
6480 /* Store the value in the bitfield. */
6481 store_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
6482 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6483 mode, temp);
6485 return const0_rtx;
6487 else
6489 /* Now build a reference to just the desired component. */
6490 rtx to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6492 if (to_rtx == target)
6493 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
6495 if (!MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) && MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) != 0)
6496 set_mem_alias_set (to_rtx, alias_set);
6498 return store_expr (exp, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal);
6502 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, a BIT_FIELD_REF,
6503 an ARRAY_REF, or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for nested operations of these
6504 codes and find the ultimate containing object, which we return.
6506 We set *PBITSIZE to the size in bits that we want, *PBITPOS to the
6507 bit position, and *PUNSIGNEDP to the signedness of the field.
6508 If the position of the field is variable, we store a tree
6509 giving the variable offset (in units) in *POFFSET.
6510 This offset is in addition to the bit position.
6511 If the position is not variable, we store 0 in *POFFSET.
6513 If any of the extraction expressions is volatile,
6514 we store 1 in *PVOLATILEP. Otherwise we don't change that.
6516 If the field is a non-BLKmode bit-field, *PMODE is set to VOIDmode.
6517 Otherwise, it is a mode that can be used to access the field.
6519 If the field describes a variable-sized object, *PMODE is set to
6520 BLKmode and *PBITSIZE is set to -1. An access cannot be made in
6521 this case, but the address of the object can be found.
6523 If KEEP_ALIGNING is true and the target is STRICT_ALIGNMENT, we don't
6524 look through nodes that serve as markers of a greater alignment than
6525 the one that can be deduced from the expression. These nodes make it
6526 possible for front-ends to prevent temporaries from being created by
6527 the middle-end on alignment considerations. For that purpose, the
6528 normal operating mode at high-level is to always pass FALSE so that
6529 the ultimate containing object is really returned; moreover, the
6530 associated predicate handled_component_p will always return TRUE
6531 on these nodes, thus indicating that they are essentially handled
6532 by get_inner_reference. TRUE should only be passed when the caller
6533 is scanning the expression in order to build another representation
6534 and specifically knows how to handle these nodes; as such, this is
6535 the normal operating mode in the RTL expanders. */
6537 tree
6538 get_inner_reference (tree exp, HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitsize,
6539 HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitpos, tree *poffset,
6540 enum machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp,
6541 int *pvolatilep, bool keep_aligning)
6543 tree size_tree = 0;
6544 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
6545 bool blkmode_bitfield = false;
6546 tree offset = size_zero_node;
6547 double_int bit_offset = double_int_zero;
6549 /* First get the mode, signedness, and size. We do this from just the
6550 outermost expression. */
6551 *pbitsize = -1;
6552 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
6554 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6555 size_tree = DECL_SIZE (field);
6556 if (!DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
6557 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
6558 else if (DECL_MODE (field) == BLKmode)
6559 blkmode_bitfield = true;
6560 else if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
6561 && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
6562 /* Volatile bitfields should be accessed in the mode of the
6563 field's type, not the mode computed based on the bit
6564 size. */
6565 mode = TYPE_MODE (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field));
6567 *punsignedp = DECL_UNSIGNED (field);
6569 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
6571 size_tree = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6572 *punsignedp = (! INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6573 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6575 /* For vector types, with the correct size of access, use the mode of
6576 inner type. */
6577 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == VECTOR_TYPE
6578 && TREE_TYPE (exp) == TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
6579 && tree_int_cst_equal (size_tree, TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))))
6580 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6582 else
6584 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6585 *punsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6587 if (mode == BLKmode)
6588 size_tree = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6589 else
6590 *pbitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
6593 if (size_tree != 0)
6595 if (! host_integerp (size_tree, 1))
6596 mode = BLKmode, *pbitsize = -1;
6597 else
6598 *pbitsize = tree_low_cst (size_tree, 1);
6601 /* Compute cumulative bit-offset for nested component-refs and array-refs,
6602 and find the ultimate containing object. */
6603 while (1)
6605 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6607 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6608 bit_offset += tree_to_double_int (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
6609 break;
6611 case COMPONENT_REF:
6613 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6614 tree this_offset = component_ref_field_offset (exp);
6616 /* If this field hasn't been filled in yet, don't go past it.
6617 This should only happen when folding expressions made during
6618 type construction. */
6619 if (this_offset == 0)
6620 break;
6622 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset, this_offset);
6623 bit_offset += tree_to_double_int (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field));
6625 /* ??? Right now we don't do anything with DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN. */
6627 break;
6629 case ARRAY_REF:
6630 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6632 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6633 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
6634 tree unit_size = array_ref_element_size (exp);
6636 /* We assume all arrays have sizes that are a multiple of a byte.
6637 First subtract the lower bound, if any, in the type of the
6638 index, then convert to sizetype and multiply by the size of
6639 the array element. */
6640 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
6641 index = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
6642 index, low_bound);
6644 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
6645 size_binop (MULT_EXPR,
6646 fold_convert (sizetype, index),
6647 unit_size));
6649 break;
6651 case REALPART_EXPR:
6652 break;
6654 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
6655 bit_offset += double_int::from_uhwi (*pbitsize);
6656 break;
6658 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
6659 if (keep_aligning && STRICT_ALIGNMENT
6660 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6661 > TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
6662 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
6663 < BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
6664 && (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6665 || TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
6666 goto done;
6667 break;
6669 case MEM_REF:
6670 /* Hand back the decl for MEM[&decl, off]. */
6671 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR)
6673 tree off = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6674 if (!integer_zerop (off))
6676 double_int boff, coff = mem_ref_offset (exp);
6677 boff = coff.alshift (BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6678 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT),
6679 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT);
6680 bit_offset += boff;
6682 exp = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
6684 goto done;
6686 default:
6687 goto done;
6690 /* If any reference in the chain is volatile, the effect is volatile. */
6691 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
6692 *pvolatilep = 1;
6694 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6696 done:
6698 /* If OFFSET is constant, see if we can return the whole thing as a
6699 constant bit position. Make sure to handle overflow during
6700 this conversion. */
6701 if (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST)
6703 double_int tem = tree_to_double_int (offset);
6704 tem = tem.sext (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype));
6705 tem = tem.alshift (BITS_PER_UNIT == 8 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT),
6706 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT);
6707 tem += bit_offset;
6708 if (tem.fits_shwi ())
6710 *pbitpos = tem.to_shwi ();
6711 *poffset = offset = NULL_TREE;
6715 /* Otherwise, split it up. */
6716 if (offset)
6718 /* Avoid returning a negative bitpos as this may wreak havoc later. */
6719 if (bit_offset.is_negative ())
6721 double_int mask
6722 = double_int::mask (BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6723 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT));
6724 double_int tem = bit_offset.and_not (mask);
6725 /* TEM is the bitpos rounded to BITS_PER_UNIT towards -Inf.
6726 Subtract it to BIT_OFFSET and add it (scaled) to OFFSET. */
6727 bit_offset -= tem;
6728 tem = tem.arshift (BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6729 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT),
6730 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT);
6731 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
6732 double_int_to_tree (sizetype, tem));
6735 *pbitpos = bit_offset.to_shwi ();
6736 *poffset = offset;
6739 /* We can use BLKmode for a byte-aligned BLKmode bitfield. */
6740 if (mode == VOIDmode
6741 && blkmode_bitfield
6742 && (*pbitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
6743 && (*pbitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0)
6744 *pmode = BLKmode;
6745 else
6746 *pmode = mode;
6748 return exp;
6751 /* Return a tree of sizetype representing the size, in bytes, of the element
6752 of EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6754 tree
6755 array_ref_element_size (tree exp)
6757 tree aligned_size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 3);
6758 tree elmt_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6759 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
6761 /* If a size was specified in the ARRAY_REF, it's the size measured
6762 in alignment units of the element type. So multiply by that value. */
6763 if (aligned_size)
6765 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
6766 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
6767 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_size) != sizetype)
6768 aligned_size = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, aligned_size);
6769 return size_binop_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, aligned_size,
6770 size_int (TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (elmt_type)));
6773 /* Otherwise, take the size from that of the element type. Substitute
6774 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
6775 else
6776 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elmt_type), exp);
6779 /* Return a tree representing the lower bound of the array mentioned in
6780 EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6782 tree
6783 array_ref_low_bound (tree exp)
6785 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6787 /* If a lower bound is specified in EXP, use it. */
6788 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))
6789 return TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
6791 /* Otherwise, if there is a domain type and it has a lower bound, use it,
6792 substituting for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
6793 if (domain_type && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type))
6794 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
6796 /* Otherwise, return a zero of the appropriate type. */
6797 return build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)), 0);
6800 /* Returns true if REF is an array reference to an array at the end of
6801 a structure. If this is the case, the array may be allocated larger
6802 than its upper bound implies. */
6804 bool
6805 array_at_struct_end_p (tree ref)
6807 if (TREE_CODE (ref) != ARRAY_REF
6808 && TREE_CODE (ref) != ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
6809 return false;
6811 while (handled_component_p (ref))
6813 /* If the reference chain contains a component reference to a
6814 non-union type and there follows another field the reference
6815 is not at the end of a structure. */
6816 if (TREE_CODE (ref) == COMPONENT_REF
6817 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0))) == RECORD_TYPE)
6819 tree nextf = DECL_CHAIN (TREE_OPERAND (ref, 1));
6820 while (nextf && TREE_CODE (nextf) != FIELD_DECL)
6821 nextf = DECL_CHAIN (nextf);
6822 if (nextf)
6823 return false;
6826 ref = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0);
6829 /* If the reference is based on a declared entity, the size of the array
6830 is constrained by its given domain. */
6831 if (DECL_P (ref))
6832 return false;
6834 return true;
6837 /* Return a tree representing the upper bound of the array mentioned in
6838 EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6840 tree
6841 array_ref_up_bound (tree exp)
6843 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6845 /* If there is a domain type and it has an upper bound, use it, substituting
6846 for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
6847 if (domain_type && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type))
6848 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
6850 /* Otherwise fail. */
6851 return NULL_TREE;
6854 /* Return a tree representing the offset, in bytes, of the field referenced
6855 by EXP. This does not include any offset in DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET. */
6857 tree
6858 component_ref_field_offset (tree exp)
6860 tree aligned_offset = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
6861 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6862 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
6864 /* If an offset was specified in the COMPONENT_REF, it's the offset measured
6865 in units of DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN / BITS_PER_UNIT. So multiply by that
6866 value. */
6867 if (aligned_offset)
6869 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
6870 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
6871 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_offset) != sizetype)
6872 aligned_offset = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, aligned_offset);
6873 return size_binop_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, aligned_offset,
6874 size_int (DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN (field)
6875 / BITS_PER_UNIT));
6878 /* Otherwise, take the offset from that of the field. Substitute
6879 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
6880 else
6881 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), exp);
6884 /* Alignment in bits the TARGET of an assignment may be assumed to have. */
6886 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
6887 target_align (const_tree target)
6889 /* We might have a chain of nested references with intermediate misaligning
6890 bitfields components, so need to recurse to find out. */
6892 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT this_align, outer_align;
6894 switch (TREE_CODE (target))
6896 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6897 return 1;
6899 case COMPONENT_REF:
6900 this_align = DECL_ALIGN (TREE_OPERAND (target, 1));
6901 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6902 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
6904 case ARRAY_REF:
6905 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6906 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6907 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6908 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
6910 CASE_CONVERT:
6911 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
6912 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
6913 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6914 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6915 return MAX (this_align, outer_align);
6917 default:
6918 return TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6923 /* Given an rtx VALUE that may contain additions and multiplications, return
6924 an equivalent value that just refers to a register, memory, or constant.
6925 This is done by generating instructions to perform the arithmetic and
6926 returning a pseudo-register containing the value.
6928 The returned value may be a REG, SUBREG, MEM or constant. */
6931 force_operand (rtx value, rtx target)
6933 rtx op1, op2;
6934 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
6935 rtx subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
6936 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (value);
6938 /* Check for subreg applied to an expression produced by loop optimizer. */
6939 if (code == SUBREG
6940 && !REG_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
6941 && !MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
6943 value
6944 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
6945 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6946 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
6947 NULL_RTX)),
6948 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6949 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
6950 code = GET_CODE (value);
6953 /* Check for a PIC address load. */
6954 if ((code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
6955 && XEXP (value, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
6956 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF
6957 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == LABEL_REF
6958 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == CONST))
6960 if (!subtarget)
6961 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
6962 emit_move_insn (subtarget, value);
6963 return subtarget;
6966 if (ARITHMETIC_P (value))
6968 op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
6969 if (!CONSTANT_P (op2) && !(REG_P (op2) && op2 != subtarget))
6970 subtarget = 0;
6971 if (code == MINUS && CONST_INT_P (op2))
6973 code = PLUS;
6974 op2 = negate_rtx (GET_MODE (value), op2);
6977 /* Check for an addition with OP2 a constant integer and our first
6978 operand a PLUS of a virtual register and something else. In that
6979 case, we want to emit the sum of the virtual register and the
6980 constant first and then add the other value. This allows virtual
6981 register instantiation to simply modify the constant rather than
6982 creating another one around this addition. */
6983 if (code == PLUS && CONST_INT_P (op2)
6984 && GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 0)) == PLUS
6985 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0))
6986 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
6987 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
6989 rtx temp = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code,
6990 XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0), op2,
6991 subtarget, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6992 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, temp,
6993 force_operand (XEXP (XEXP (value,
6994 0), 1), 0),
6995 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6998 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
6999 op2 = force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX);
7000 switch (code)
7002 case MULT:
7003 return expand_mult (GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 1);
7004 case DIV:
7005 if (!INTEGRAL_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value)))
7006 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7007 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7008 else
7009 return expand_divmod (0,
7010 FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value))
7011 ? RDIV_EXPR : TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
7012 GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 0);
7013 case MOD:
7014 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7015 target, 0);
7016 case UDIV:
7017 return expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7018 target, 1);
7019 case UMOD:
7020 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7021 target, 1);
7022 case ASHIFTRT:
7023 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7024 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7025 default:
7026 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7027 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7030 if (UNARY_P (value))
7032 if (!target)
7033 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
7034 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL_RTX);
7035 switch (code)
7037 case ZERO_EXTEND:
7038 case SIGN_EXTEND:
7039 case TRUNCATE:
7040 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
7041 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
7042 convert_move (target, op1, code == ZERO_EXTEND);
7043 return target;
7045 case FIX:
7046 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
7047 expand_fix (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FIX);
7048 return target;
7050 case FLOAT:
7051 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
7052 expand_float (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
7053 return target;
7055 default:
7056 return expand_simple_unop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, target, 0);
7060 #ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
7061 /* On machines that have insn scheduling, we want all memory reference to be
7062 explicit, so we need to deal with such paradoxical SUBREGs. */
7063 if (paradoxical_subreg_p (value) && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
7064 value
7065 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
7066 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7067 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
7068 NULL_RTX)),
7069 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7070 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
7071 #endif
7073 return value;
7076 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return nonzero iff there is no way that
7077 EXP can reference X, which is being modified. TOP_P is nonzero if this
7078 call is going to be used to determine whether we need a temporary
7079 for EXP, as opposed to a recursive call to this function.
7081 It is always safe for this routine to return zero since it merely
7082 searches for optimization opportunities. */
7085 safe_from_p (const_rtx x, tree exp, int top_p)
7087 rtx exp_rtl = 0;
7088 int i, nops;
7090 if (x == 0
7091 /* If EXP has varying size, we MUST use a target since we currently
7092 have no way of allocating temporaries of variable size
7093 (except for arrays that have TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE set).
7094 So we assume here that something at a higher level has prevented a
7095 clash. This is somewhat bogus, but the best we can do. Only
7096 do this when X is BLKmode and when we are at the top level. */
7097 || (top_p && TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
7098 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != INTEGER_CST
7099 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != ARRAY_TYPE
7100 || TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == NULL_TREE
7101 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7102 != INTEGER_CST)
7103 && GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode)
7104 /* If X is in the outgoing argument area, it is always safe. */
7105 || (MEM_P (x)
7106 && (XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx
7107 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
7108 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx))))
7109 return 1;
7111 /* If this is a subreg of a hard register, declare it unsafe, otherwise,
7112 find the underlying pseudo. */
7113 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
7115 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
7116 if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7117 return 0;
7120 /* Now look at our tree code and possibly recurse. */
7121 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)))
7123 case tcc_declaration:
7124 exp_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (exp);
7125 break;
7127 case tcc_constant:
7128 return 1;
7130 case tcc_exceptional:
7131 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TREE_LIST)
7133 while (1)
7135 if (TREE_VALUE (exp) && !safe_from_p (x, TREE_VALUE (exp), 0))
7136 return 0;
7137 exp = TREE_CHAIN (exp);
7138 if (!exp)
7139 return 1;
7140 if (TREE_CODE (exp) != TREE_LIST)
7141 return safe_from_p (x, exp, 0);
7144 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
7146 constructor_elt *ce;
7147 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
7149 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce)
7150 if ((ce->index != NULL_TREE && !safe_from_p (x, ce->index, 0))
7151 || !safe_from_p (x, ce->value, 0))
7152 return 0;
7153 return 1;
7155 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
7156 return 1; /* An already-visited SAVE_EXPR? */
7157 else
7158 return 0;
7160 case tcc_statement:
7161 /* The only case we look at here is the DECL_INITIAL inside a
7162 DECL_EXPR. */
7163 return (TREE_CODE (exp) != DECL_EXPR
7164 || TREE_CODE (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)) != VAR_DECL
7165 || !DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp))
7166 || safe_from_p (x, DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)), 0));
7168 case tcc_binary:
7169 case tcc_comparison:
7170 if (!safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
7171 return 0;
7172 /* Fall through. */
7174 case tcc_unary:
7175 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7177 case tcc_expression:
7178 case tcc_reference:
7179 case tcc_vl_exp:
7180 /* Now do code-specific tests. EXP_RTL is set to any rtx we find in
7181 the expression. If it is set, we conflict iff we are that rtx or
7182 both are in memory. Otherwise, we check all operands of the
7183 expression recursively. */
7185 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7187 case ADDR_EXPR:
7188 /* If the operand is static or we are static, we can't conflict.
7189 Likewise if we don't conflict with the operand at all. */
7190 if (staticp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
7191 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
7192 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
7193 return 1;
7195 /* Otherwise, the only way this can conflict is if we are taking
7196 the address of a DECL a that address if part of X, which is
7197 very rare. */
7198 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7199 if (DECL_P (exp))
7201 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (exp)
7202 || !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (exp)))
7203 return 0;
7204 else
7205 exp_rtl = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
7207 break;
7209 case MEM_REF:
7210 if (MEM_P (x)
7211 && alias_sets_conflict_p (MEM_ALIAS_SET (x),
7212 get_alias_set (exp)))
7213 return 0;
7214 break;
7216 case CALL_EXPR:
7217 /* Assume that the call will clobber all hard registers and
7218 all of memory. */
7219 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7220 || MEM_P (x))
7221 return 0;
7222 break;
7224 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
7225 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
7226 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
7227 gcc_unreachable ();
7229 case SAVE_EXPR:
7230 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7232 default:
7233 break;
7236 /* If we have an rtx, we do not need to scan our operands. */
7237 if (exp_rtl)
7238 break;
7240 nops = TREE_OPERAND_LENGTH (exp);
7241 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
7242 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0
7243 && ! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, i), 0))
7244 return 0;
7246 break;
7248 case tcc_type:
7249 /* Should never get a type here. */
7250 gcc_unreachable ();
7253 /* If we have an rtl, find any enclosed object. Then see if we conflict
7254 with it. */
7255 if (exp_rtl)
7257 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == SUBREG)
7259 exp_rtl = SUBREG_REG (exp_rtl);
7260 if (REG_P (exp_rtl)
7261 && REGNO (exp_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7262 return 0;
7265 /* If the rtl is X, then it is not safe. Otherwise, it is unless both
7266 are memory and they conflict. */
7267 return ! (rtx_equal_p (x, exp_rtl)
7268 || (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (exp_rtl)
7269 && true_dependence (exp_rtl, VOIDmode, x)));
7272 /* If we reach here, it is safe. */
7273 return 1;
7277 /* Return the highest power of two that EXP is known to be a multiple of.
7278 This is used in updating alignment of MEMs in array references. */
7280 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7281 highest_pow2_factor (const_tree exp)
7283 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c0, c1;
7285 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7287 case INTEGER_CST:
7288 /* We can find the lowest bit that's a one. If the low
7289 HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT bits are zero, return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT.
7290 We need to handle this case since we can find it in a COND_EXPR,
7291 a MIN_EXPR, or a MAX_EXPR. If the constant overflows, we have an
7292 erroneous program, so return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT to avoid any
7293 later ICE. */
7294 if (TREE_OVERFLOW (exp))
7295 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
7296 else
7298 /* Note: tree_low_cst is intentionally not used here,
7299 we don't care about the upper bits. */
7300 c0 = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp);
7301 c0 &= -c0;
7302 return c0 ? c0 : BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
7304 break;
7306 case PLUS_EXPR: case MINUS_EXPR: case MIN_EXPR: case MAX_EXPR:
7307 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7308 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7309 return MIN (c0, c1);
7311 case MULT_EXPR:
7312 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7313 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7314 return c0 * c1;
7316 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR: case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR: case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
7317 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
7318 if (integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
7319 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
7321 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7322 c1 = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1);
7323 return MAX (1, c0 / c1);
7325 break;
7327 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
7328 /* The highest power of two of a bit-and expression is the maximum of
7329 that of its operands. We typically get here for a complex LHS and
7330 a constant negative power of two on the RHS to force an explicit
7331 alignment, so don't bother looking at the LHS. */
7332 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7334 CASE_CONVERT:
7335 case SAVE_EXPR:
7336 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7338 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
7339 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7341 case COND_EXPR:
7342 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7343 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
7344 return MIN (c0, c1);
7346 default:
7347 break;
7350 return 1;
7353 /* Similar, except that the alignment requirements of TARGET are
7354 taken into account. Assume it is at least as aligned as its
7355 type, unless it is a COMPONENT_REF in which case the layout of
7356 the structure gives the alignment. */
7358 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7359 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree target, const_tree exp)
7361 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT talign = target_align (target) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
7362 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT factor = highest_pow2_factor (exp);
7364 return MAX (factor, talign);
7367 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
7368 /* Convert the tree comparison code TCODE to the rtl one where the
7369 signedness is UNSIGNEDP. */
7371 static enum rtx_code
7372 convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (enum tree_code tcode, int unsignedp)
7374 enum rtx_code code;
7375 switch (tcode)
7377 case EQ_EXPR:
7378 code = EQ;
7379 break;
7380 case NE_EXPR:
7381 code = NE;
7382 break;
7383 case LT_EXPR:
7384 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
7385 break;
7386 case LE_EXPR:
7387 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
7388 break;
7389 case GT_EXPR:
7390 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
7391 break;
7392 case GE_EXPR:
7393 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
7394 break;
7395 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
7396 code = UNORDERED;
7397 break;
7398 case ORDERED_EXPR:
7399 code = ORDERED;
7400 break;
7401 case UNLT_EXPR:
7402 code = UNLT;
7403 break;
7404 case UNLE_EXPR:
7405 code = UNLE;
7406 break;
7407 case UNGT_EXPR:
7408 code = UNGT;
7409 break;
7410 case UNGE_EXPR:
7411 code = UNGE;
7412 break;
7413 case UNEQ_EXPR:
7414 code = UNEQ;
7415 break;
7416 case LTGT_EXPR:
7417 code = LTGT;
7418 break;
7420 default:
7421 gcc_unreachable ();
7423 return code;
7425 #endif
7427 /* Subroutine of expand_expr. Expand the two operands of a binary
7428 expression EXP0 and EXP1 placing the results in OP0 and OP1.
7429 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero. The
7430 MODIFIER argument is as documented by expand_expr. */
7432 static void
7433 expand_operands (tree exp0, tree exp1, rtx target, rtx *op0, rtx *op1,
7434 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7436 if (! safe_from_p (target, exp1, 1))
7437 target = 0;
7438 if (operand_equal_p (exp0, exp1, 0))
7440 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
7441 *op1 = copy_rtx (*op0);
7443 else
7445 /* If we need to preserve evaluation order, copy exp0 into its own
7446 temporary variable so that it can't be clobbered by exp1. */
7447 if (flag_evaluation_order && TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp1))
7448 exp0 = save_expr (exp0);
7449 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
7450 *op1 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
7455 /* Return a MEM that contains constant EXP. DEFER is as for
7456 output_constant_def and MODIFIER is as for expand_expr. */
7458 static rtx
7459 expand_expr_constant (tree exp, int defer, enum expand_modifier modifier)
7461 rtx mem;
7463 mem = output_constant_def (exp, defer);
7464 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7465 mem = use_anchored_address (mem);
7466 return mem;
7469 /* A subroutine of expand_expr_addr_expr. Evaluate the address of EXP.
7470 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
7472 static rtx
7473 expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7474 enum expand_modifier modifier, addr_space_t as)
7476 rtx result, subtarget;
7477 tree inner, offset;
7478 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
7479 int volatilep, unsignedp;
7480 enum machine_mode mode1;
7482 /* If we are taking the address of a constant and are at the top level,
7483 we have to use output_constant_def since we can't call force_const_mem
7484 at top level. */
7485 /* ??? This should be considered a front-end bug. We should not be
7486 generating ADDR_EXPR of something that isn't an LVALUE. The only
7487 exception here is STRING_CST. */
7488 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (exp))
7490 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (exp, 0, modifier), 0);
7491 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7492 result = force_operand (result, target);
7493 return result;
7496 /* Everything must be something allowed by is_gimple_addressable. */
7497 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7499 case INDIRECT_REF:
7500 /* This case will happen via recursion for &a->b. */
7501 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
7503 case MEM_REF:
7505 tree tem = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7506 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
7507 tem = fold_build_pointer_plus (tem, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7508 return expand_expr (tem, target, tmode, modifier);
7511 case CONST_DECL:
7512 /* Expand the initializer like constants above. */
7513 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (DECL_INITIAL (exp),
7514 0, modifier), 0);
7515 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7516 result = force_operand (result, target);
7517 return result;
7519 case REALPART_EXPR:
7520 /* The real part of the complex number is always first, therefore
7521 the address is the same as the address of the parent object. */
7522 offset = 0;
7523 bitpos = 0;
7524 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7525 break;
7527 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
7528 /* The imaginary part of the complex number is always second.
7529 The expression is therefore always offset by the size of the
7530 scalar type. */
7531 offset = 0;
7532 bitpos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
7533 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7534 break;
7536 default:
7537 /* If the object is a DECL, then expand it for its rtl. Don't bypass
7538 expand_expr, as that can have various side effects; LABEL_DECLs for
7539 example, may not have their DECL_RTL set yet. Expand the rtl of
7540 CONSTRUCTORs too, which should yield a memory reference for the
7541 constructor's contents. Assume language specific tree nodes can
7542 be expanded in some interesting way. */
7543 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) < LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE);
7544 if (DECL_P (exp)
7545 || TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
7546 || TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR)
7548 result = expand_expr (exp, target, tmode,
7549 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7550 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
7552 /* If the DECL isn't in memory, then the DECL wasn't properly
7553 marked TREE_ADDRESSABLE, which will be either a front-end
7554 or a tree optimizer bug. */
7556 if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7557 && ! MEM_P (result)
7558 && ! targetm.calls.allocate_stack_slots_for_args())
7560 error ("local frame unavailable (naked function?)");
7561 return result;
7563 else
7564 gcc_assert (MEM_P (result));
7565 result = XEXP (result, 0);
7567 /* ??? Is this needed anymore? */
7568 if (DECL_P (exp))
7569 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
7571 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7572 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7573 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
7574 result = force_operand (result, target);
7575 return result;
7578 /* Pass FALSE as the last argument to get_inner_reference although
7579 we are expanding to RTL. The rationale is that we know how to
7580 handle "aligning nodes" here: we can just bypass them because
7581 they won't change the final object whose address will be returned
7582 (they actually exist only for that purpose). */
7583 inner = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
7584 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
7585 break;
7588 /* We must have made progress. */
7589 gcc_assert (inner != exp);
7591 subtarget = offset || bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
7592 /* For VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, where the outer alignment is bigger than
7593 inner alignment, force the inner to be sufficiently aligned. */
7594 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (inner)
7595 && TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) < TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7597 inner = copy_node (inner);
7598 TREE_TYPE (inner) = copy_node (TREE_TYPE (inner));
7599 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7600 TYPE_USER_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = 1;
7602 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (inner, subtarget, tmode, modifier, as);
7604 if (offset)
7606 rtx tmp;
7608 if (modifier != EXPAND_NORMAL)
7609 result = force_operand (result, NULL);
7610 tmp = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, tmode,
7611 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7612 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_NORMAL);
7614 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7615 tmp = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, tmp, as);
7617 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7618 result = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, tmode, result, tmp);
7619 else
7621 subtarget = bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
7622 result = expand_simple_binop (tmode, PLUS, result, tmp, subtarget,
7623 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7627 if (bitpos)
7629 /* Someone beforehand should have rejected taking the address
7630 of such an object. */
7631 gcc_assert ((bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
7633 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7634 result = plus_constant (tmode, result, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7635 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7636 result = force_operand (result, target);
7639 return result;
7642 /* A subroutine of expand_expr. Evaluate EXP, which is an ADDR_EXPR.
7643 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
7645 static rtx
7646 expand_expr_addr_expr (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7647 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7649 addr_space_t as = ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC;
7650 enum machine_mode address_mode = Pmode;
7651 enum machine_mode pointer_mode = ptr_mode;
7652 enum machine_mode rmode;
7653 rtx result;
7655 /* Target mode of VOIDmode says "whatever's natural". */
7656 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
7657 tmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7659 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7661 as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
7662 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
7663 pointer_mode = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (as);
7666 /* We can get called with some Weird Things if the user does silliness
7667 like "(short) &a". In that case, convert_memory_address won't do
7668 the right thing, so ignore the given target mode. */
7669 if (tmode != address_mode && tmode != pointer_mode)
7670 tmode = address_mode;
7672 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target,
7673 tmode, modifier, as);
7675 /* Despite expand_expr claims concerning ignoring TMODE when not
7676 strictly convenient, stuff breaks if we don't honor it. Note
7677 that combined with the above, we only do this for pointer modes. */
7678 rmode = GET_MODE (result);
7679 if (rmode == VOIDmode)
7680 rmode = tmode;
7681 if (rmode != tmode)
7682 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7684 return result;
7687 /* Generate code for computing CONSTRUCTOR EXP.
7688 An rtx for the computed value is returned. If AVOID_TEMP_MEM
7689 is TRUE, instead of creating a temporary variable in memory
7690 NULL is returned and the caller needs to handle it differently. */
7692 static rtx
7693 expand_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, enum expand_modifier modifier,
7694 bool avoid_temp_mem)
7696 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
7697 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7699 /* Try to avoid creating a temporary at all. This is possible
7700 if all of the initializer is zero.
7701 FIXME: try to handle all [0..255] initializers we can handle
7702 with memset. */
7703 if (TREE_STATIC (exp)
7704 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7705 && target != 0 && mode == BLKmode
7706 && all_zeros_p (exp))
7708 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
7709 return target;
7712 /* All elts simple constants => refer to a constant in memory. But
7713 if this is a non-BLKmode mode, let it store a field at a time
7714 since that should make a CONST_INT or CONST_DOUBLE when we
7715 fold. Likewise, if we have a target we can use, it is best to
7716 store directly into the target unless the type is large enough
7717 that memcpy will be used. If we are making an initializer and
7718 all operands are constant, put it in memory as well.
7720 FIXME: Avoid trying to fill vector constructors piece-meal.
7721 Output them with output_constant_def below unless we're sure
7722 they're zeros. This should go away when vector initializers
7723 are treated like VECTOR_CST instead of arrays. */
7724 if ((TREE_STATIC (exp)
7725 && ((mode == BLKmode
7726 && ! (target != 0 && safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)))
7727 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7728 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1)
7729 && (! MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
7730 (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1),
7731 TYPE_ALIGN (type)))
7732 && ! mostly_zeros_p (exp))))
7733 || ((modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
7734 && TREE_CONSTANT (exp)))
7736 rtx constructor;
7738 if (avoid_temp_mem)
7739 return NULL_RTX;
7741 constructor = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
7743 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7744 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7745 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
7746 constructor = validize_mem (constructor);
7748 return constructor;
7751 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
7752 locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
7753 if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
7754 || GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7756 if (avoid_temp_mem)
7757 return NULL_RTX;
7759 target
7760 = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type, (TYPE_QUALS (type)
7761 | (TREE_READONLY (exp)
7762 * TYPE_QUAL_CONST))),
7763 TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp), 1);
7766 store_constructor (exp, target, 0, int_expr_size (exp));
7767 return target;
7771 /* expand_expr: generate code for computing expression EXP.
7772 An rtx for the computed value is returned. The value is never null.
7773 In the case of a void EXP, const0_rtx is returned.
7775 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero.
7776 TARGET is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
7777 the rtx returned may not be the same as TARGET.
7779 If TARGET is CONST0_RTX, it means that the value will be ignored.
7781 If TMODE is not VOIDmode, it suggests generating the
7782 result in mode TMODE. But this is done only when convenient.
7783 Otherwise, TMODE is ignored and the value generated in its natural mode.
7784 TMODE is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
7785 the rtx returned may not have mode TMODE.
7787 Note that TARGET may have neither TMODE nor MODE. In that case, it
7788 probably will not be used.
7790 If MODIFIER is EXPAND_SUM then when EXP is an addition
7791 we can return an rtx of the form (MULT (REG ...) (CONST_INT ...))
7792 or a nest of (PLUS ...) and (MINUS ...) where the terms are
7793 products as above, or REG or MEM, or constant.
7794 Ordinarily in such cases we would output mul or add instructions
7795 and then return a pseudo reg containing the sum.
7797 EXPAND_INITIALIZER is much like EXPAND_SUM except that
7798 it also marks a label as absolutely required (it can't be dead).
7799 It also makes a ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND instead of emitting extend insns.
7800 This is used for outputting expressions used in initializers.
7802 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS says that it is okay to return a MEM
7803 with a constant address even if that address is not normally legitimate.
7804 EXPAND_INITIALIZER and EXPAND_SUM also have this effect.
7806 EXPAND_STACK_PARM is used when expanding to a TARGET on the stack for
7807 a call parameter. Such targets require special care as we haven't yet
7808 marked TARGET so that it's safe from being trashed by libcalls. We
7809 don't want to use TARGET for anything but the final result;
7810 Intermediate values must go elsewhere. Additionally, calls to
7811 emit_block_move will be flagged with BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM.
7813 If EXP is a VAR_DECL whose DECL_RTL was a MEM with an invalid
7814 address, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL, then *ALT_RTL is set to the
7815 DECL_RTL of the VAR_DECL. *ALT_RTL is also set if EXP is a
7816 COMPOUND_EXPR whose second argument is such a VAR_DECL, and so on
7817 recursively. */
7820 expand_expr_real (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7821 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
7823 rtx ret;
7825 /* Handle ERROR_MARK before anybody tries to access its type. */
7826 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK
7827 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == ERROR_MARK))
7829 ret = CONST0_RTX (tmode);
7830 return ret ? ret : const0_rtx;
7833 /* If this is an expression of some kind and it has an associated line
7834 number, then emit the line number before expanding the expression.
7836 We need to save and restore the file and line information so that
7837 errors discovered during expansion are emitted with the right
7838 information. It would be better of the diagnostic routines
7839 used the file/line information embedded in the tree nodes rather
7840 than globals. */
7841 if (cfun && EXPR_HAS_LOCATION (exp))
7843 location_t saved_location = input_location;
7844 location_t saved_curr_loc = curr_insn_location ();
7845 input_location = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
7846 set_curr_insn_location (input_location);
7848 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
7850 input_location = saved_location;
7851 set_curr_insn_location (saved_curr_loc);
7853 else
7855 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
7858 return ret;
7861 /* Try to expand the conditional expression which is represented by
7862 TREEOP0 ? TREEOP1 : TREEOP2 using conditonal moves. If succeseds
7863 return the rtl reg which repsents the result. Otherwise return
7864 NULL_RTL. */
7866 static rtx
7867 expand_cond_expr_using_cmove (tree treeop0 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7868 tree treeop1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7869 tree treeop2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7871 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
7872 rtx insn;
7873 rtx op00, op01, op1, op2;
7874 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
7875 enum machine_mode comparison_mode;
7876 gimple srcstmt;
7877 rtx temp;
7878 tree type = TREE_TYPE (treeop1);
7879 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
7880 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7882 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1);
7884 /* If we cannot do a conditional move on the mode, try doing it
7885 with the promoted mode. */
7886 if (!can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
7887 mode = promote_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp);
7889 if (!can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
7890 return NULL_RTX;
7892 start_sequence ();
7893 expand_operands (treeop1, treeop2,
7894 temp, &op1, &op2, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7896 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == SSA_NAME
7897 && (srcstmt = get_def_for_expr_class (treeop0, tcc_comparison)))
7899 tree type = TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt));
7900 enum tree_code cmpcode = gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt);
7901 op00 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt));
7902 op01 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt));
7903 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7904 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
7905 comparison_code = convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (cmpcode, unsignedp);
7907 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (treeop0)) == tcc_comparison)
7909 tree type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0));
7910 enum tree_code cmpcode = TREE_CODE (treeop0);
7911 op00 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0));
7912 op01 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1));
7913 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
7914 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7915 comparison_code = convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (cmpcode, unsignedp);
7917 else
7919 op00 = expand_normal (treeop0);
7920 op01 = const0_rtx;
7921 comparison_code = NE;
7922 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
7925 if (GET_MODE (op1) != mode)
7926 op1 = gen_lowpart (mode, op1);
7928 if (GET_MODE (op2) != mode)
7929 op2 = gen_lowpart (mode, op2);
7931 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
7932 insn = emit_conditional_move (temp, comparison_code,
7933 op00, op01, comparison_mode,
7934 op1, op2, mode,
7935 unsignedp);
7937 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
7938 and return. */
7939 if (insn)
7941 rtx seq = get_insns ();
7942 end_sequence ();
7943 emit_insn (seq);
7944 return temp;
7947 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
7948 branches. */
7949 end_sequence ();
7950 #endif
7951 return NULL_RTX;
7955 expand_expr_real_2 (sepops ops, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7956 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7958 rtx op0, op1, op2, temp;
7959 tree type;
7960 int unsignedp;
7961 enum machine_mode mode;
7962 enum tree_code code = ops->code;
7963 optab this_optab;
7964 rtx subtarget, original_target;
7965 int ignore;
7966 bool reduce_bit_field;
7967 location_t loc = ops->location;
7968 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
7969 #define REDUCE_BIT_FIELD(expr) (reduce_bit_field \
7970 ? reduce_to_bit_field_precision ((expr), \
7971 target, \
7972 type) \
7973 : (expr))
7975 type = ops->type;
7976 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7977 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
7979 treeop0 = ops->op0;
7980 treeop1 = ops->op1;
7981 treeop2 = ops->op2;
7983 /* We should be called only on simple (binary or unary) expressions,
7984 exactly those that are valid in gimple expressions that aren't
7985 GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS (or invalid). */
7986 gcc_assert (get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS
7987 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS
7988 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS);
7990 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
7991 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
7992 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
7993 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
7995 /* We should be called only if we need the result. */
7996 gcc_assert (!ignore);
7998 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
7999 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
8000 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
8001 reduce_bit_field = (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
8002 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type));
8004 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8005 target = 0;
8007 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
8008 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
8009 original_target = target;
8011 switch (code)
8013 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
8014 case PAREN_EXPR:
8015 CASE_CONVERT:
8016 if (treeop0 == error_mark_node)
8017 return const0_rtx;
8019 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
8021 tree valtype = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8023 /* If both input and output are BLKmode, this conversion isn't doing
8024 anything except possibly changing memory attribute. */
8025 if (mode == BLKmode && TYPE_MODE (valtype) == BLKmode)
8027 rtx result = expand_expr (treeop0, target, tmode,
8028 modifier);
8030 result = copy_rtx (result);
8031 set_mem_attributes (result, type, 0);
8032 return result;
8035 if (target == 0)
8037 if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode)
8038 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
8039 else
8040 target = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
8043 if (MEM_P (target))
8044 /* Store data into beginning of memory target. */
8045 store_expr (treeop0,
8046 adjust_address (target, TYPE_MODE (valtype), 0),
8047 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
8048 false);
8050 else
8052 gcc_assert (REG_P (target));
8054 /* Store this field into a union of the proper type. */
8055 store_field (target,
8056 MIN ((int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE
8057 (treeop0))
8058 * BITS_PER_UNIT),
8059 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)),
8060 0, 0, 0, TYPE_MODE (valtype), treeop0,
8061 type, 0, false);
8064 /* Return the entire union. */
8065 return target;
8068 if (mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8070 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, target, VOIDmode,
8071 modifier);
8073 /* If the signedness of the conversion differs and OP0 is
8074 a promoted SUBREG, clear that indication since we now
8075 have to do the proper extension. */
8076 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != unsignedp
8077 && GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
8078 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0) = 0;
8080 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8083 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, mode,
8084 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier);
8085 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
8088 /* If OP0 is a constant, just convert it into the proper mode. */
8089 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
8091 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8092 enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (op0);
8094 if (inner_mode == VOIDmode)
8095 inner_mode = TYPE_MODE (inner_type);
8097 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8098 op0 = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, op0, inner_mode,
8099 subreg_lowpart_offset (mode,
8100 inner_mode));
8101 else
8102 op0= convert_modes (mode, inner_mode, op0,
8103 TYPE_UNSIGNED (inner_type));
8106 else if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8107 op0 = gen_rtx_fmt_e (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND, mode, op0);
8109 else if (target == 0)
8110 op0 = convert_to_mode (mode, op0,
8111 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
8112 (treeop0)));
8113 else
8115 convert_move (target, op0,
8116 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8117 op0 = target;
8120 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8122 case ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT_EXPR:
8124 tree treeop0_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8125 addr_space_t as_to;
8126 addr_space_t as_from;
8128 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (type));
8129 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (treeop0_type));
8131 as_to = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (type));
8132 as_from = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0_type));
8134 /* Conversions between pointers to the same address space should
8135 have been implemented via CONVERT_EXPR / NOP_EXPR. */
8136 gcc_assert (as_to != as_from);
8138 /* Ask target code to handle conversion between pointers
8139 to overlapping address spaces. */
8140 if (targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_to, as_from)
8141 || targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_from, as_to))
8143 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
8144 op0 = targetm.addr_space.convert (op0, treeop0_type, type);
8145 gcc_assert (op0);
8146 return op0;
8149 /* For disjoint address spaces, converting anything but
8150 a null pointer invokes undefined behaviour. We simply
8151 always return a null pointer here. */
8152 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
8155 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
8156 /* Even though the sizetype mode and the pointer's mode can be different
8157 expand is able to handle this correctly and get the correct result out
8158 of the PLUS_EXPR code. */
8159 /* Make sure to sign-extend the sizetype offset in a POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
8160 if sizetype precision is smaller than pointer precision. */
8161 if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) < TYPE_PRECISION (type))
8162 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type,
8163 fold_convert_loc (loc, ssizetype,
8164 treeop1));
8165 /* If sizetype precision is larger than pointer precision, truncate the
8166 offset to have matching modes. */
8167 else if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) > TYPE_PRECISION (type))
8168 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type, treeop1);
8170 case PLUS_EXPR:
8171 /* If we are adding a constant, a VAR_DECL that is sp, fp, or ap, and
8172 something else, make sure we add the register to the constant and
8173 then to the other thing. This case can occur during strength
8174 reduction and doing it this way will produce better code if the
8175 frame pointer or argument pointer is eliminated.
8177 fold-const.c will ensure that the constant is always in the inner
8178 PLUS_EXPR, so the only case we need to do anything about is if
8179 sp, ap, or fp is our second argument, in which case we must swap
8180 the innermost first argument and our second argument. */
8182 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == PLUS_EXPR
8183 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
8184 && TREE_CODE (treeop1) == VAR_DECL
8185 && (DECL_RTL (treeop1) == frame_pointer_rtx
8186 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == stack_pointer_rtx
8187 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == arg_pointer_rtx))
8189 gcc_unreachable ();
8192 /* If the result is to be ptr_mode and we are adding an integer to
8193 something, we might be forming a constant. So try to use
8194 plus_constant. If it produces a sum and we can't accept it,
8195 use force_operand. This allows P = &ARR[const] to generate
8196 efficient code on machines where a SYMBOL_REF is not a valid
8197 address.
8199 If this is an EXPAND_SUM call, always return the sum. */
8200 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8201 || (mode == ptr_mode && (unsignedp || ! flag_trapv)))
8203 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8204 target = 0;
8205 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST
8206 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8207 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop1))
8209 rtx constant_part;
8211 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8212 EXPAND_SUM);
8213 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
8214 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8215 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8216 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8217 constant_part
8218 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop0),
8219 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
8220 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)));
8221 op1 = plus_constant (mode, op1, INTVAL (constant_part));
8222 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8223 op1 = force_operand (op1, target);
8224 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op1);
8227 else if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
8228 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8229 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop0))
8231 rtx constant_part;
8233 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8234 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8235 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_SUM));
8236 if (! CONSTANT_P (op0))
8238 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, NULL_RTX,
8239 VOIDmode, modifier);
8240 /* Return a PLUS if modifier says it's OK. */
8241 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM
8242 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8243 return simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1);
8244 goto binop2;
8246 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
8247 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8248 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8249 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8250 constant_part
8251 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1),
8252 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
8253 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8254 op0 = plus_constant (mode, op0, INTVAL (constant_part));
8255 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8256 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
8257 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8261 /* Use TER to expand pointer addition of a negated value
8262 as pointer subtraction. */
8263 if ((POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8264 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == VECTOR_TYPE
8265 && POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))))
8266 && TREE_CODE (treeop1) == SSA_NAME
8267 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8268 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)))
8270 gimple def = get_def_for_expr (treeop1, NEGATE_EXPR);
8271 if (def)
8273 treeop1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def);
8274 code = MINUS_EXPR;
8275 goto do_minus;
8279 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8280 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8281 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8282 zero-extend. */
8283 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8284 || mode != ptr_mode)
8286 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8287 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8288 if (op0 == const0_rtx)
8289 return op1;
8290 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
8291 return op0;
8292 goto binop2;
8295 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8296 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8297 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
8299 case MINUS_EXPR:
8300 do_minus:
8301 /* For initializers, we are allowed to return a MINUS of two
8302 symbolic constants. Here we handle all cases when both operands
8303 are constant. */
8304 /* Handle difference of two symbolic constants,
8305 for the sake of an initializer. */
8306 if ((modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8307 && really_constant_p (treeop0)
8308 && really_constant_p (treeop1))
8310 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8311 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8313 /* If the last operand is a CONST_INT, use plus_constant of
8314 the negated constant. Else make the MINUS. */
8315 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
8316 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (plus_constant (mode, op0,
8317 -INTVAL (op1)));
8318 else
8319 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, op0, op1));
8322 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8323 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8324 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8325 zero-extend. */
8326 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8327 || mode != ptr_mode)
8328 goto binop;
8330 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8331 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8333 /* Convert A - const to A + (-const). */
8334 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
8336 op1 = negate_rtx (mode, op1);
8337 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
8340 goto binop2;
8342 case WIDEN_MULT_PLUS_EXPR:
8343 case WIDEN_MULT_MINUS_EXPR:
8344 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8345 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8346 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
8347 target, unsignedp);
8348 return target;
8350 case WIDEN_MULT_EXPR:
8351 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
8352 Thus the following special case checks need only
8353 check the second operand. */
8354 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
8356 tree t1 = treeop0;
8357 treeop0 = treeop1;
8358 treeop1 = t1;
8361 /* First, check if we have a multiplication of one signed and one
8362 unsigned operand. */
8363 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) != INTEGER_CST
8364 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8365 != TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))))
8367 enum machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8368 this_optab = usmul_widen_optab;
8369 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8370 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8372 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8373 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
8374 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8375 else
8376 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op1, &op0,
8377 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8378 goto binop3;
8381 /* Check for a multiplication with matching signedness. */
8382 else if ((TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
8383 && int_fits_type_p (treeop1, TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8384 || (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))
8385 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))))
8387 tree op0type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8388 enum machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (op0type);
8389 bool zextend_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (op0type);
8390 optab other_optab = zextend_p ? smul_widen_optab : umul_widen_optab;
8391 this_optab = zextend_p ? umul_widen_optab : smul_widen_optab;
8393 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) != INTEGER_CST)
8395 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8396 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8398 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
8399 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8400 temp = expand_widening_mult (mode, op0, op1, target,
8401 unsignedp, this_optab);
8402 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8404 if (find_widening_optab_handler (other_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8405 != CODE_FOR_nothing
8406 && innermode == word_mode)
8408 rtx htem, hipart;
8409 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8410 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST)
8411 op1 = convert_modes (innermode, mode,
8412 expand_normal (treeop1), unsignedp);
8413 else
8414 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8415 temp = expand_binop (mode, other_optab, op0, op1, target,
8416 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8417 hipart = gen_highpart (innermode, temp);
8418 htem = expand_mult_highpart_adjust (innermode, hipart,
8419 op0, op1, hipart,
8420 zextend_p);
8421 if (htem != hipart)
8422 emit_move_insn (hipart, htem);
8423 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8427 treeop0 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop0);
8428 treeop1 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop1);
8429 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8430 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
8432 case FMA_EXPR:
8434 optab opt = fma_optab;
8435 gimple def0, def2;
8437 /* If there is no insn for FMA, emit it as __builtin_fma{,f,l}
8438 call. */
8439 if (optab_handler (fma_optab, mode) == CODE_FOR_nothing)
8441 tree fn = mathfn_built_in (TREE_TYPE (treeop0), BUILT_IN_FMA);
8442 tree call_expr;
8444 gcc_assert (fn != NULL_TREE);
8445 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, treeop0, treeop1, treeop2);
8446 return expand_builtin (call_expr, target, subtarget, mode, false);
8449 def0 = get_def_for_expr (treeop0, NEGATE_EXPR);
8450 def2 = get_def_for_expr (treeop2, NEGATE_EXPR);
8452 op0 = op2 = NULL;
8454 if (def0 && def2
8455 && optab_handler (fnms_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8457 opt = fnms_optab;
8458 op0 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def0));
8459 op2 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def2));
8461 else if (def0
8462 && optab_handler (fnma_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8464 opt = fnma_optab;
8465 op0 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def0));
8467 else if (def2
8468 && optab_handler (fms_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8470 opt = fms_optab;
8471 op2 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def2));
8474 if (op0 == NULL)
8475 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8476 if (op2 == NULL)
8477 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8478 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8480 return expand_ternary_op (TYPE_MODE (type), opt,
8481 op0, op1, op2, target, 0);
8484 case MULT_EXPR:
8485 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8486 below because "expand_mult" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8487 multiplications. */
8488 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8489 goto binop;
8491 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
8492 Thus the following special case checks need only
8493 check the second operand. */
8494 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
8496 tree t1 = treeop0;
8497 treeop0 = treeop1;
8498 treeop1 = t1;
8501 /* Attempt to return something suitable for generating an
8502 indexed address, for machines that support that. */
8504 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM && mode == ptr_mode
8505 && host_integerp (treeop1, 0))
8507 tree exp1 = treeop1;
8509 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8510 EXPAND_SUM);
8512 if (!REG_P (op0))
8513 op0 = force_operand (op0, NULL_RTX);
8514 if (!REG_P (op0))
8515 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op0);
8517 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MULT (mode, op0,
8518 gen_int_mode (tree_low_cst (exp1, 0),
8519 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp1)))));
8522 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8523 target = 0;
8525 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8526 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
8528 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
8529 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
8530 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
8531 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
8532 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
8533 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8534 below because "expand_divmod" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8535 divisions. */
8536 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8537 goto binop;
8539 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8540 target = 0;
8541 /* Possible optimization: compute the dividend with EXPAND_SUM
8542 then if the divisor is constant can optimize the case
8543 where some terms of the dividend have coeffs divisible by it. */
8544 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8545 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8546 return expand_divmod (0, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8548 case RDIV_EXPR:
8549 goto binop;
8551 case MULT_HIGHPART_EXPR:
8552 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8553 temp = expand_mult_highpart (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8554 gcc_assert (temp);
8555 return temp;
8557 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
8558 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
8559 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
8560 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
8561 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8562 target = 0;
8563 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8564 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8565 return expand_divmod (1, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8567 case FIXED_CONVERT_EXPR:
8568 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8569 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8570 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8572 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == INTEGER_TYPE
8573 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8574 || (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)))
8575 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 1, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
8576 else
8577 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 0, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
8578 return target;
8580 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
8581 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8582 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8583 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8584 expand_fix (target, op0, unsignedp);
8585 return target;
8587 case FLOAT_EXPR:
8588 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8589 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8590 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8591 /* expand_float can't figure out what to do if FROM has VOIDmode.
8592 So give it the correct mode. With -O, cse will optimize this. */
8593 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
8594 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)),
8595 op0);
8596 expand_float (target, op0,
8597 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8598 return target;
8600 case NEGATE_EXPR:
8601 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8602 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8603 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8604 target = 0;
8605 temp = expand_unop (mode,
8606 optab_for_tree_code (NEGATE_EXPR, type,
8607 optab_default),
8608 op0, target, 0);
8609 gcc_assert (temp);
8610 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8612 case ABS_EXPR:
8613 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8614 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8615 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8616 target = 0;
8618 /* ABS_EXPR is not valid for complex arguments. */
8619 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
8620 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT);
8622 /* Unsigned abs is simply the operand. Testing here means we don't
8623 risk generating incorrect code below. */
8624 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8625 return op0;
8627 return expand_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp,
8628 safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1));
8630 case MAX_EXPR:
8631 case MIN_EXPR:
8632 target = original_target;
8633 if (target == 0
8634 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8635 || (MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
8636 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
8637 || (REG_P (target)
8638 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
8639 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8640 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8641 target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8643 /* First try to do it with a special MIN or MAX instruction.
8644 If that does not win, use a conditional jump to select the proper
8645 value. */
8646 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8647 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
8648 OPTAB_WIDEN);
8649 if (temp != 0)
8650 return temp;
8652 /* At this point, a MEM target is no longer useful; we will get better
8653 code without it. */
8655 if (! REG_P (target))
8656 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8658 /* If op1 was placed in target, swap op0 and op1. */
8659 if (target != op0 && target == op1)
8661 temp = op0;
8662 op0 = op1;
8663 op1 = temp;
8666 /* We generate better code and avoid problems with op1 mentioning
8667 target by forcing op1 into a pseudo if it isn't a constant. */
8668 if (! CONSTANT_P (op1))
8669 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
8672 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
8673 rtx cmpop1 = op1;
8675 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
8676 comparison_code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
8677 else
8678 comparison_code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
8680 /* Canonicalize to comparisons against 0. */
8681 if (op1 == const1_rtx)
8683 /* Converting (a >= 1 ? a : 1) into (a > 0 ? a : 1)
8684 or (a != 0 ? a : 1) for unsigned.
8685 For MIN we are safe converting (a <= 1 ? a : 1)
8686 into (a <= 0 ? a : 1) */
8687 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
8688 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
8689 comparison_code = unsignedp ? NE : GT;
8691 if (op1 == constm1_rtx && !unsignedp)
8693 /* Converting (a >= -1 ? a : -1) into (a >= 0 ? a : -1)
8694 and (a <= -1 ? a : -1) into (a < 0 ? a : -1) */
8695 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
8696 if (code == MIN_EXPR)
8697 comparison_code = LT;
8699 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
8700 /* Use a conditional move if possible. */
8701 if (can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
8703 rtx insn;
8705 /* ??? Same problem as in expmed.c: emit_conditional_move
8706 forces a stack adjustment via compare_from_rtx, and we
8707 lose the stack adjustment if the sequence we are about
8708 to create is discarded. */
8709 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
8711 start_sequence ();
8713 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
8714 insn = emit_conditional_move (target, comparison_code,
8715 op0, cmpop1, mode,
8716 op0, op1, mode,
8717 unsignedp);
8719 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
8720 and return. */
8721 if (insn)
8723 rtx seq = get_insns ();
8724 end_sequence ();
8725 emit_insn (seq);
8726 return target;
8729 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
8730 branches. */
8731 end_sequence ();
8733 #endif
8734 if (target != op0)
8735 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
8737 temp = gen_label_rtx ();
8738 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (target, cmpop1, comparison_code,
8739 unsignedp, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, temp,
8740 -1);
8742 emit_move_insn (target, op1);
8743 emit_label (temp);
8744 return target;
8746 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
8747 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8748 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8749 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8750 target = 0;
8751 /* In case we have to reduce the result to bitfield precision
8752 for unsigned bitfield expand this as XOR with a proper constant
8753 instead. */
8754 if (reduce_bit_field && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8755 temp = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, op0,
8756 immed_double_int_const
8757 (double_int::mask (TYPE_PRECISION (type)), mode),
8758 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8759 else
8760 temp = expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, op0, target, 1);
8761 gcc_assert (temp);
8762 return temp;
8764 /* ??? Can optimize bitwise operations with one arg constant.
8765 Can optimize (a bitwise1 n) bitwise2 (a bitwise3 b)
8766 and (a bitwise1 b) bitwise2 b (etc)
8767 but that is probably not worth while. */
8769 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
8770 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
8771 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
8772 goto binop;
8774 case LROTATE_EXPR:
8775 case RROTATE_EXPR:
8776 gcc_assert (VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type))
8777 || (GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (type))
8778 == TYPE_PRECISION (type)));
8779 /* fall through */
8781 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
8782 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
8783 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8784 below because "expand_shift" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8785 shifts. */
8786 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8787 goto binop;
8789 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, treeop1, 1))
8790 subtarget = 0;
8791 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8792 target = 0;
8793 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8794 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8795 temp = expand_variable_shift (code, mode, op0, treeop1, target,
8796 unsignedp);
8797 if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR)
8798 temp = REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8799 return temp;
8801 /* Could determine the answer when only additive constants differ. Also,
8802 the addition of one can be handled by changing the condition. */
8803 case LT_EXPR:
8804 case LE_EXPR:
8805 case GT_EXPR:
8806 case GE_EXPR:
8807 case EQ_EXPR:
8808 case NE_EXPR:
8809 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
8810 case ORDERED_EXPR:
8811 case UNLT_EXPR:
8812 case UNLE_EXPR:
8813 case UNGT_EXPR:
8814 case UNGE_EXPR:
8815 case UNEQ_EXPR:
8816 case LTGT_EXPR:
8817 temp = do_store_flag (ops,
8818 modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? target : NULL_RTX,
8819 tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
8820 if (temp)
8821 return temp;
8823 /* Use a compare and a jump for BLKmode comparisons, or for function
8824 type comparisons is HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare. */
8826 if ((target == 0
8827 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8828 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1)
8829 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop1, 1)
8830 /* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
8831 value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
8832 || (!optimize && REG_P (target)
8833 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
8834 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
8836 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
8838 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
8839 jumpifnot_1 (code, treeop0, treeop1, op1, -1);
8841 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == 1 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8842 emit_move_insn (target, constm1_rtx);
8843 else
8844 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
8846 emit_label (op1);
8847 return target;
8849 case COMPLEX_EXPR:
8850 /* Get the rtx code of the operands. */
8851 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8852 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8854 if (!target)
8855 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
8857 /* Move the real (op0) and imaginary (op1) parts to their location. */
8858 write_complex_part (target, op0, false);
8859 write_complex_part (target, op1, true);
8861 return target;
8863 case WIDEN_SUM_EXPR:
8865 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
8866 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
8868 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8869 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, op1,
8870 target, unsignedp);
8871 return target;
8874 case REDUC_MAX_EXPR:
8875 case REDUC_MIN_EXPR:
8876 case REDUC_PLUS_EXPR:
8878 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8879 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8880 temp = expand_unop (mode, this_optab, op0, target, unsignedp);
8881 gcc_assert (temp);
8882 return temp;
8885 case VEC_LSHIFT_EXPR:
8886 case VEC_RSHIFT_EXPR:
8888 target = expand_vec_shift_expr (ops, target);
8889 return target;
8892 case VEC_UNPACK_HI_EXPR:
8893 case VEC_UNPACK_LO_EXPR:
8895 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8896 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
8897 target, unsignedp);
8898 gcc_assert (temp);
8899 return temp;
8902 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_HI_EXPR:
8903 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_LO_EXPR:
8905 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8906 /* The signedness is determined from input operand. */
8907 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr
8908 (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
8909 target, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8911 gcc_assert (temp);
8912 return temp;
8915 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_HI_EXPR:
8916 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_LO_EXPR:
8917 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_EVEN_EXPR:
8918 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_ODD_EXPR:
8919 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_HI_EXPR:
8920 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_LO_EXPR:
8921 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8922 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, NULL_RTX,
8923 target, unsignedp);
8924 gcc_assert (target);
8925 return target;
8927 case VEC_PACK_TRUNC_EXPR:
8928 case VEC_PACK_SAT_EXPR:
8929 case VEC_PACK_FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
8930 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8931 goto binop;
8933 case VEC_PERM_EXPR:
8934 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8935 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8937 /* Careful here: if the target doesn't support integral vector modes,
8938 a constant selection vector could wind up smooshed into a normal
8939 integral constant. */
8940 if (CONSTANT_P (op2) && GET_CODE (op2) != CONST_VECTOR)
8942 tree sel_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop2);
8943 enum machine_mode vmode
8944 = mode_for_vector (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (sel_type)),
8945 TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (sel_type));
8946 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (vmode) == MODE_VECTOR_INT);
8947 op2 = simplify_subreg (vmode, op2, TYPE_MODE (sel_type), 0);
8948 gcc_assert (op2 && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_VECTOR);
8950 else
8951 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op2)) == MODE_VECTOR_INT);
8953 temp = expand_vec_perm (mode, op0, op1, op2, target);
8954 gcc_assert (temp);
8955 return temp;
8957 case DOT_PROD_EXPR:
8959 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
8960 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
8961 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
8962 rtx op2;
8964 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8965 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
8966 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
8967 target, unsignedp);
8968 return target;
8971 case REALIGN_LOAD_EXPR:
8973 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
8974 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
8975 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
8976 rtx op2;
8978 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8979 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8980 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
8981 temp = expand_ternary_op (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, op2,
8982 target, unsignedp);
8983 gcc_assert (temp);
8984 return temp;
8987 case COND_EXPR:
8988 /* A COND_EXPR with its type being VOID_TYPE represents a
8989 conditional jump and is handled in
8990 expand_gimple_cond_expr. */
8991 gcc_assert (!VOID_TYPE_P (type));
8993 /* Note that COND_EXPRs whose type is a structure or union
8994 are required to be constructed to contain assignments of
8995 a temporary variable, so that we can evaluate them here
8996 for side effect only. If type is void, we must do likewise. */
8998 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)
8999 && !ignore
9000 && TREE_TYPE (treeop1) != void_type_node
9001 && TREE_TYPE (treeop2) != void_type_node);
9003 temp = expand_cond_expr_using_cmove (treeop0, treeop1, treeop2);
9004 if (temp)
9005 return temp;
9007 /* If we are not to produce a result, we have no target. Otherwise,
9008 if a target was specified use it; it will not be used as an
9009 intermediate target unless it is safe. If no target, use a
9010 temporary. */
9012 if (modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9013 && original_target
9014 && safe_from_p (original_target, treeop0, 1)
9015 && GET_MODE (original_target) == mode
9016 && !MEM_P (original_target))
9017 temp = original_target;
9018 else
9019 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1);
9021 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9022 NO_DEFER_POP;
9023 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
9024 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
9025 jumpifnot (treeop0, op0, -1);
9026 store_expr (treeop1, temp,
9027 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
9028 false);
9030 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (op1));
9031 emit_barrier ();
9032 emit_label (op0);
9033 store_expr (treeop2, temp,
9034 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
9035 false);
9037 emit_label (op1);
9038 OK_DEFER_POP;
9039 return temp;
9041 case VEC_COND_EXPR:
9042 target = expand_vec_cond_expr (type, treeop0, treeop1, treeop2, target);
9043 return target;
9045 default:
9046 gcc_unreachable ();
9049 /* Here to do an ordinary binary operator. */
9050 binop:
9051 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9052 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9053 binop2:
9054 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
9055 binop3:
9056 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9057 target = 0;
9058 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
9059 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
9060 gcc_assert (temp);
9061 /* Bitwise operations do not need bitfield reduction as we expect their
9062 operands being properly truncated. */
9063 if (code == BIT_XOR_EXPR
9064 || code == BIT_AND_EXPR
9065 || code == BIT_IOR_EXPR)
9066 return temp;
9067 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
9069 #undef REDUCE_BIT_FIELD
9072 expand_expr_real_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
9073 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
9075 rtx op0, op1, temp, decl_rtl;
9076 tree type;
9077 int unsignedp;
9078 enum machine_mode mode;
9079 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
9080 rtx subtarget, original_target;
9081 int ignore;
9082 tree context;
9083 bool reduce_bit_field;
9084 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
9085 struct separate_ops ops;
9086 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
9087 tree ssa_name = NULL_TREE;
9088 gimple g;
9090 type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
9091 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9092 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
9094 treeop0 = treeop1 = treeop2 = NULL_TREE;
9095 if (!VL_EXP_CLASS_P (exp))
9096 switch (TREE_CODE_LENGTH (code))
9098 default:
9099 case 3: treeop2 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
9100 case 2: treeop1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9101 case 1: treeop0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9102 case 0: break;
9104 ops.code = code;
9105 ops.type = type;
9106 ops.op0 = treeop0;
9107 ops.op1 = treeop1;
9108 ops.op2 = treeop2;
9109 ops.location = loc;
9111 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
9112 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
9113 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
9114 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
9116 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
9117 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
9118 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
9119 reduce_bit_field = (!ignore
9120 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
9121 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type));
9123 /* If we are going to ignore this result, we need only do something
9124 if there is a side-effect somewhere in the expression. If there
9125 is, short-circuit the most common cases here. Note that we must
9126 not call expand_expr with anything but const0_rtx in case this
9127 is an initial expansion of a size that contains a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. */
9129 if (ignore)
9131 if (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp))
9132 return const0_rtx;
9134 /* Ensure we reference a volatile object even if value is ignored, but
9135 don't do this if all we are doing is taking its address. */
9136 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
9137 && TREE_CODE (exp) != FUNCTION_DECL
9138 && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
9139 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
9141 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
9142 if (MEM_P (temp))
9143 copy_to_reg (temp);
9144 return const0_rtx;
9147 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_unary
9148 || code == BIT_FIELD_REF
9149 || code == COMPONENT_REF
9150 || code == INDIRECT_REF)
9151 return expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
9152 modifier);
9154 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_binary
9155 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison
9156 || code == ARRAY_REF || code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
9158 expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9159 expand_expr (treeop1, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9160 return const0_rtx;
9163 target = 0;
9166 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9167 target = 0;
9169 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
9170 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
9171 original_target = target;
9173 switch (code)
9175 case LABEL_DECL:
9177 tree function = decl_function_context (exp);
9179 temp = label_rtx (exp);
9180 temp = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, temp);
9182 if (function != current_function_decl
9183 && function != 0)
9184 LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (temp) = 1;
9186 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, temp);
9187 return temp;
9190 case SSA_NAME:
9191 /* ??? ivopts calls expander, without any preparation from
9192 out-of-ssa. So fake instructions as if this was an access to the
9193 base variable. This unnecessarily allocates a pseudo, see how we can
9194 reuse it, if partition base vars have it set already. */
9195 if (!currently_expanding_to_rtl)
9197 tree var = SSA_NAME_VAR (exp);
9198 if (var && DECL_RTL_SET_P (var))
9199 return DECL_RTL (var);
9200 return gen_raw_REG (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9201 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1);
9204 g = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (exp);
9205 /* For EXPAND_INITIALIZER try harder to get something simpler. */
9206 if (g == NULL
9207 && modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9208 && !SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (exp)
9209 && (optimize || DECL_IGNORED_P (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp)))
9210 && stmt_is_replaceable_p (SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp)))
9211 g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp);
9212 if (g)
9214 rtx r = expand_expr_real (gimple_assign_rhs_to_tree (g), target,
9215 tmode, modifier, NULL);
9216 if (REG_P (r) && !REG_EXPR (r))
9217 set_reg_attrs_for_decl_rtl (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp), r);
9218 return r;
9221 ssa_name = exp;
9222 decl_rtl = get_rtx_for_ssa_name (ssa_name);
9223 exp = SSA_NAME_VAR (ssa_name);
9224 goto expand_decl_rtl;
9226 case PARM_DECL:
9227 case VAR_DECL:
9228 /* If a static var's type was incomplete when the decl was written,
9229 but the type is complete now, lay out the decl now. */
9230 if (DECL_SIZE (exp) == 0
9231 && COMPLETE_OR_UNBOUND_ARRAY_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
9232 && (TREE_STATIC (exp) || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)))
9233 layout_decl (exp, 0);
9235 /* ... fall through ... */
9237 case FUNCTION_DECL:
9238 case RESULT_DECL:
9239 decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (exp);
9240 expand_decl_rtl:
9241 gcc_assert (decl_rtl);
9242 decl_rtl = copy_rtx (decl_rtl);
9243 /* Record writes to register variables. */
9244 if (modifier == EXPAND_WRITE
9245 && REG_P (decl_rtl)
9246 && HARD_REGISTER_P (decl_rtl))
9247 add_to_hard_reg_set (&crtl->asm_clobbers,
9248 GET_MODE (decl_rtl), REGNO (decl_rtl));
9250 /* Ensure variable marked as used even if it doesn't go through
9251 a parser. If it hasn't be used yet, write out an external
9252 definition. */
9253 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
9255 /* Show we haven't gotten RTL for this yet. */
9256 temp = 0;
9258 /* Variables inherited from containing functions should have
9259 been lowered by this point. */
9260 context = decl_function_context (exp);
9261 gcc_assert (!context
9262 || context == current_function_decl
9263 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
9264 || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)
9265 /* ??? C++ creates functions that are not TREE_STATIC. */
9266 || TREE_CODE (exp) == FUNCTION_DECL);
9268 /* This is the case of an array whose size is to be determined
9269 from its initializer, while the initializer is still being parsed.
9270 ??? We aren't parsing while expanding anymore. */
9272 if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && REG_P (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)))
9273 temp = validize_mem (decl_rtl);
9275 /* If DECL_RTL is memory, we are in the normal case and the
9276 address is not valid, get the address into a register. */
9278 else if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9280 if (alt_rtl)
9281 *alt_rtl = decl_rtl;
9282 decl_rtl = use_anchored_address (decl_rtl);
9283 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9284 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
9285 && !memory_address_addr_space_p (DECL_MODE (exp),
9286 XEXP (decl_rtl, 0),
9287 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (decl_rtl)))
9288 temp = replace_equiv_address (decl_rtl,
9289 copy_rtx (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)));
9292 /* If we got something, return it. But first, set the alignment
9293 if the address is a register. */
9294 if (temp != 0)
9296 if (MEM_P (temp) && REG_P (XEXP (temp, 0)))
9297 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (temp, 0), DECL_ALIGN (exp));
9299 return temp;
9302 /* If the mode of DECL_RTL does not match that of the decl,
9303 there are two cases: we are dealing with a BLKmode value
9304 that is returned in a register, or we are dealing with
9305 a promoted value. In the latter case, return a SUBREG
9306 of the wanted mode, but mark it so that we know that it
9307 was already extended. */
9308 if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
9309 && DECL_MODE (exp) != BLKmode
9310 && GET_MODE (decl_rtl) != DECL_MODE (exp))
9312 enum machine_mode pmode;
9314 /* Get the signedness to be used for this variable. Ensure we get
9315 the same mode we got when the variable was declared. */
9316 if (code == SSA_NAME
9317 && (g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (ssa_name))
9318 && gimple_code (g) == GIMPLE_CALL)
9320 gcc_assert (!gimple_call_internal_p (g));
9321 pmode = promote_function_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp,
9322 gimple_call_fntype (g),
9325 else
9326 pmode = promote_decl_mode (exp, &unsignedp);
9327 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == pmode);
9329 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, decl_rtl);
9330 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
9331 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
9332 return temp;
9335 return decl_rtl;
9337 case INTEGER_CST:
9338 temp = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp),
9339 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (exp), mode);
9341 return temp;
9343 case VECTOR_CST:
9345 tree tmp = NULL_TREE;
9346 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_INT
9347 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT
9348 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FRACT
9349 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_UFRACT
9350 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_ACCUM
9351 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_UACCUM)
9352 return const_vector_from_tree (exp);
9353 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
9355 tree type_for_mode = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, 1);
9356 if (type_for_mode)
9357 tmp = fold_unary_loc (loc, VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, type_for_mode, exp);
9359 if (!tmp)
9361 VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *v;
9362 unsigned i;
9363 v = VEC_alloc (constructor_elt, gc, VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp));
9364 for (i = 0; i < VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp); ++i)
9365 CONSTRUCTOR_APPEND_ELT (v, NULL_TREE, VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i));
9366 tmp = build_constructor (type, v);
9368 return expand_expr (tmp, ignore ? const0_rtx : target,
9369 tmode, modifier);
9372 case CONST_DECL:
9373 return expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, VOIDmode, modifier);
9375 case REAL_CST:
9376 /* If optimized, generate immediate CONST_DOUBLE
9377 which will be turned into memory by reload if necessary.
9379 We used to force a register so that loop.c could see it. But
9380 this does not allow gen_* patterns to perform optimizations with
9381 the constants. It also produces two insns in cases like "x = 1.0;".
9382 On most machines, floating-point constants are not permitted in
9383 many insns, so we'd end up copying it to a register in any case.
9385 Now, we do the copying in expand_binop, if appropriate. */
9386 return CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (exp),
9387 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9389 case FIXED_CST:
9390 return CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (exp),
9391 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9393 case COMPLEX_CST:
9394 /* Handle evaluating a complex constant in a CONCAT target. */
9395 if (original_target && GET_CODE (original_target) == CONCAT)
9397 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9398 rtx rtarg, itarg;
9400 rtarg = XEXP (original_target, 0);
9401 itarg = XEXP (original_target, 1);
9403 /* Move the real and imaginary parts separately. */
9404 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_REALPART (exp), rtarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9405 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_IMAGPART (exp), itarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9407 if (op0 != rtarg)
9408 emit_move_insn (rtarg, op0);
9409 if (op1 != itarg)
9410 emit_move_insn (itarg, op1);
9412 return original_target;
9415 /* ... fall through ... */
9417 case STRING_CST:
9418 temp = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
9420 /* temp contains a constant address.
9421 On RISC machines where a constant address isn't valid,
9422 make some insns to get that address into a register. */
9423 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9424 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9425 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
9426 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (mode, XEXP (temp, 0),
9427 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (temp)))
9428 return replace_equiv_address (temp,
9429 copy_rtx (XEXP (temp, 0)));
9430 return temp;
9432 case SAVE_EXPR:
9434 tree val = treeop0;
9435 rtx ret = expand_expr_real_1 (val, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
9437 if (!SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp))
9439 /* We can indeed still hit this case, typically via builtin
9440 expanders calling save_expr immediately before expanding
9441 something. Assume this means that we only have to deal
9442 with non-BLKmode values. */
9443 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (ret) != BLKmode);
9445 val = build_decl (EXPR_LOCATION (exp),
9446 VAR_DECL, NULL, TREE_TYPE (exp));
9447 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (val) = 1;
9448 DECL_IGNORED_P (val) = 1;
9449 treeop0 = val;
9450 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = treeop0;
9451 SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp) = 1;
9453 if (!CONSTANT_P (ret))
9454 ret = copy_to_reg (ret);
9455 SET_DECL_RTL (val, ret);
9458 return ret;
9462 case CONSTRUCTOR:
9463 /* If we don't need the result, just ensure we evaluate any
9464 subexpressions. */
9465 if (ignore)
9467 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
9468 tree value;
9470 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
9471 expand_expr (value, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9473 return const0_rtx;
9476 return expand_constructor (exp, target, modifier, false);
9478 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
9480 addr_space_t as
9481 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
9482 struct mem_address addr;
9483 enum insn_code icode;
9484 unsigned int align;
9486 get_address_description (exp, &addr);
9487 op0 = addr_for_mem_ref (&addr, as, true);
9488 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
9489 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
9490 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
9491 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
9492 align = get_object_alignment (exp);
9493 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
9494 && mode != BLKmode
9495 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
9496 /* If the target does not have special handling for unaligned
9497 loads of mode then it can use regular moves for them. */
9498 && ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
9499 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
9501 struct expand_operand ops[2];
9503 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
9504 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail,
9505 nor can the generator. */
9506 create_output_operand (&ops[0], NULL_RTX, mode);
9507 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], temp);
9508 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
9509 return ops[0].value;
9511 return temp;
9514 case MEM_REF:
9516 addr_space_t as
9517 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
9518 enum machine_mode address_mode;
9519 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9520 gimple def_stmt;
9521 enum insn_code icode;
9522 unsigned align;
9523 /* Handle expansion of non-aliased memory with non-BLKmode. That
9524 might end up in a register. */
9525 if (mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (exp))
9527 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = mem_ref_offset (exp).low;
9528 tree bit_offset;
9529 tree bftype;
9530 base = TREE_OPERAND (base, 0);
9531 if (offset == 0
9532 && host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), 1)
9533 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (base))
9534 == TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))))
9535 return expand_expr (build1 (VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR,
9536 TREE_TYPE (exp), base),
9537 target, tmode, modifier);
9538 bit_offset = bitsize_int (offset * BITS_PER_UNIT);
9539 bftype = TREE_TYPE (base);
9540 if (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != BLKmode)
9541 bftype = TREE_TYPE (exp);
9542 else
9544 temp = assign_stack_temp (DECL_MODE (base),
9545 GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (base)));
9546 store_expr (base, temp, 0, false);
9547 temp = adjust_address (temp, BLKmode, offset);
9548 set_mem_size (temp, int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9549 return temp;
9551 return expand_expr (build3 (BIT_FIELD_REF, bftype,
9552 base,
9553 TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9554 bit_offset),
9555 target, tmode, modifier);
9557 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
9558 base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9559 if ((def_stmt = get_def_for_expr (base, BIT_AND_EXPR)))
9561 tree mask = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
9562 base = build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base),
9563 gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt), mask);
9564 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = base;
9566 align = get_object_alignment (exp);
9567 op0 = expand_expr (base, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
9568 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (address_mode, op0, as);
9569 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
9571 rtx off
9572 = immed_double_int_const (mem_ref_offset (exp), address_mode);
9573 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, address_mode, op0, off);
9575 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
9576 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
9577 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
9578 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
9579 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
9580 MEM_VOLATILE_P (temp) = 1;
9581 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
9582 && mode != BLKmode
9583 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
9585 if ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
9586 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
9588 struct expand_operand ops[2];
9590 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
9591 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail,
9592 nor can the generator. */
9593 create_output_operand (&ops[0], NULL_RTX, mode);
9594 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], temp);
9595 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
9596 return ops[0].value;
9598 else if (SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, align))
9599 temp = extract_bit_field (temp, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
9600 0, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9601 true, (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9602 ? NULL_RTX : target),
9603 mode, mode);
9605 return temp;
9608 case ARRAY_REF:
9611 tree array = treeop0;
9612 tree index = treeop1;
9614 /* Fold an expression like: "foo"[2].
9615 This is not done in fold so it won't happen inside &.
9616 Don't fold if this is for wide characters since it's too
9617 difficult to do correctly and this is a very rare case. */
9619 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9620 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9621 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
9623 tree t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
9625 if (t)
9626 return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
9629 /* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
9630 just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
9631 we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
9632 that was declared const. */
9634 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9635 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9636 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9637 && TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR
9638 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
9639 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
9641 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
9642 tree field, value;
9644 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (array), ix,
9645 field, value)
9646 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
9648 if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
9649 return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode, modifier);
9650 break;
9654 else if (optimize >= 1
9655 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9656 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9657 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9658 && TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
9659 && TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (array)
9660 && TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != ERROR_MARK
9661 && const_value_known_p (array))
9663 if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
9665 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (array);
9667 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
9669 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
9670 tree field, value;
9672 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), ix,
9673 field, value)
9674 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
9676 if (TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
9677 break;
9679 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
9681 /* If VALUE is a CONSTRUCTOR, this
9682 optimization is only useful if
9683 this doesn't store the CONSTRUCTOR
9684 into memory. If it does, it is more
9685 efficient to just load the data from
9686 the array directly. */
9687 rtx ret = expand_constructor (value, target,
9688 modifier, true);
9689 if (ret == NULL_RTX)
9690 break;
9693 return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode,
9694 modifier);
9697 else if(TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST)
9699 tree index1 = index;
9700 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
9701 index1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype,
9702 treeop1);
9704 /* Optimize the special-case of a zero lower bound.
9706 We convert the low_bound to sizetype to avoid some problems
9707 with constant folding. (E.g. suppose the lower bound is 1,
9708 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion,l (ARRAY
9709 +(INDEX-(unsigned char)1)) becomes ((ARRAY+(-(unsigned char)1))
9710 +INDEX), which becomes (ARRAY+255+INDEX). Opps!) */
9712 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
9713 index1 = size_diffop_loc (loc, index1,
9714 fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype,
9715 low_bound));
9717 if (0 > compare_tree_int (index1,
9718 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)))
9720 tree type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (init));
9721 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9723 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
9724 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1)
9725 return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)
9726 [TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index1)],
9727 mode);
9733 goto normal_inner_ref;
9735 case COMPONENT_REF:
9736 /* If the operand is a CONSTRUCTOR, we can just extract the
9737 appropriate field if it is present. */
9738 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == CONSTRUCTOR)
9740 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
9741 tree field, value;
9743 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (treeop0),
9744 idx, field, value)
9745 if (field == treeop1
9746 /* We can normally use the value of the field in the
9747 CONSTRUCTOR. However, if this is a bitfield in
9748 an integral mode that we can fit in a HOST_WIDE_INT,
9749 we must mask only the number of bits in the bitfield,
9750 since this is done implicitly by the constructor. If
9751 the bitfield does not meet either of those conditions,
9752 we can't do this optimization. */
9753 && (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
9754 || ((GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (field)) == MODE_INT)
9755 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (DECL_MODE (field))
9756 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))))
9758 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
9759 && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9760 target = 0;
9761 op0 = expand_expr (value, target, tmode, modifier);
9762 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
9764 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (field));
9765 enum machine_mode imode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (field));
9767 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (field)))
9769 op1 = GEN_INT (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1);
9770 op0 = expand_and (imode, op0, op1, target);
9772 else
9774 int count = GET_MODE_PRECISION (imode) - bitsize;
9776 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
9777 target, 0);
9778 op0 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
9779 target, 0);
9783 return op0;
9786 goto normal_inner_ref;
9788 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9789 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9790 normal_inner_ref:
9792 enum machine_mode mode1, mode2;
9793 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
9794 tree offset;
9795 int volatilep = 0, must_force_mem;
9796 bool packedp = false;
9797 tree tem = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
9798 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
9799 rtx orig_op0, memloc;
9800 bool mem_attrs_from_type = false;
9802 /* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
9803 we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
9804 infinitely recurse. */
9805 gcc_assert (tem != exp);
9807 if (TYPE_PACKED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
9808 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == FIELD_DECL
9809 && DECL_PACKED (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
9810 packedp = true;
9812 /* If TEM's type is a union of variable size, pass TARGET to the inner
9813 computation, since it will need a temporary and TARGET is known
9814 to have to do. This occurs in unchecked conversion in Ada. */
9815 orig_op0 = op0
9816 = expand_expr (tem,
9817 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
9818 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (tem))
9819 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
9820 != INTEGER_CST)
9821 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9822 ? target : NULL_RTX),
9823 VOIDmode,
9824 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9825 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9826 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9827 ? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
9830 /* If the bitfield is volatile, we want to access it in the
9831 field's mode, not the computed mode.
9832 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
9833 use BLKmode for it instead. */
9834 if (MEM_P (op0))
9836 if (volatilep && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
9837 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, 0);
9838 else if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
9839 op0 = adjust_address (op0, BLKmode, 0);
9842 mode2
9843 = CONSTANT_P (op0) ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) : GET_MODE (op0);
9845 /* If we have either an offset, a BLKmode result, or a reference
9846 outside the underlying object, we must force it to memory.
9847 Such a case can occur in Ada if we have unchecked conversion
9848 of an expression from a scalar type to an aggregate type or
9849 for an ARRAY_RANGE_REF whose type is BLKmode, or if we were
9850 passed a partially uninitialized object or a view-conversion
9851 to a larger size. */
9852 must_force_mem = (offset
9853 || mode1 == BLKmode
9854 || bitpos + bitsize > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode2));
9856 /* Handle CONCAT first. */
9857 if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT && !must_force_mem)
9859 if (bitpos == 0
9860 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
9861 return op0;
9862 if (bitpos == 0
9863 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9864 && bitsize)
9866 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
9867 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
9869 else if (bitpos == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9870 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 1)))
9871 && bitpos
9872 && bitsize)
9874 op0 = XEXP (op0, 1);
9875 bitpos = 0;
9876 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
9878 else
9879 /* Otherwise force into memory. */
9880 must_force_mem = 1;
9883 /* If this is a constant, put it in a register if it is a legitimate
9884 constant and we don't need a memory reference. */
9885 if (CONSTANT_P (op0)
9886 && mode2 != BLKmode
9887 && targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode2, op0)
9888 && !must_force_mem)
9889 op0 = force_reg (mode2, op0);
9891 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant, try to force it to the constant
9892 pool. Note that back-ends, e.g. MIPS, may refuse to do so if it
9893 is a legitimate constant. */
9894 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) && (memloc = force_const_mem (mode2, op0)))
9895 op0 = validize_mem (memloc);
9897 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant or the object is not in memory
9898 and need be, put it there. */
9899 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) || (!MEM_P (op0) && must_force_mem))
9901 tree nt = build_qualified_type (TREE_TYPE (tem),
9902 (TYPE_QUALS (TREE_TYPE (tem))
9903 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST));
9904 memloc = assign_temp (nt, 1, 1);
9905 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
9906 op0 = memloc;
9907 mem_attrs_from_type = true;
9910 if (offset)
9912 enum machine_mode address_mode;
9913 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
9914 EXPAND_SUM);
9916 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0));
9918 address_mode = get_address_mode (op0);
9919 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
9920 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
9922 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode
9923 /* A constant address in OP0 can have VOIDmode, we must
9924 not try to call force_reg in that case. */
9925 && GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) != VOIDmode
9926 && bitsize != 0
9927 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
9928 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
9929 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
9931 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9932 bitpos = 0;
9935 op0 = offset_address (op0, offset_rtx,
9936 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
9939 /* If OFFSET is making OP0 more aligned than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT,
9940 record its alignment as BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
9941 if (MEM_P (op0) && bitpos == 0 && offset != 0
9942 && is_aligning_offset (offset, tem))
9943 set_mem_align (op0, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
9945 /* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
9946 if (MEM_P (op0) && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
9948 if (op0 == orig_op0)
9949 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
9951 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
9954 /* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
9955 as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
9956 an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
9957 by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
9958 (which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
9959 storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode. */
9960 if (mode1 == VOIDmode
9961 || REG_P (op0) || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
9962 || (mode1 != BLKmode && ! direct_load[(int) mode1]
9963 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
9964 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
9965 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9966 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9967 /* If the field is volatile, we always want an aligned
9968 access. Do this in following two situations:
9969 1. the access is not already naturally
9970 aligned, otherwise "normal" (non-bitfield) volatile fields
9971 become non-addressable.
9972 2. the bitsize is narrower than the access size. Need
9973 to extract bitfields from the access. */
9974 || (volatilep && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0
9975 && (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0
9976 || (mode1 != BLKmode
9977 && bitsize < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode1) * BITS_PER_UNIT)))
9978 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to fetch as a memref,
9979 fetch it as a bit field. */
9980 || (mode1 != BLKmode
9981 && (((TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem)) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
9982 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0)
9983 || (MEM_P (op0)
9984 && (MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)
9985 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1) != 0))))
9986 && ((modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9987 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9988 ? STRICT_ALIGNMENT
9989 : SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode1, MEM_ALIGN (op0))))
9990 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
9991 /* If the type and the field are a constant size and the
9992 size of the type isn't the same size as the bitfield,
9993 we must use bitfield operations. */
9994 || (bitsize >= 0
9995 && TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
9996 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
9997 && 0 != compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9998 bitsize)))
10000 enum machine_mode ext_mode = mode;
10002 if (ext_mode == BLKmode
10003 && ! (target != 0 && MEM_P (op0)
10004 && MEM_P (target)
10005 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0))
10006 ext_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
10008 if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
10010 if (target == 0)
10011 target = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
10013 if (bitsize == 0)
10014 return target;
10016 /* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary and
10017 TARGET, if specified, must be a MEM. */
10018 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0)
10019 && (!target || MEM_P (target))
10020 && !(bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT));
10022 emit_block_move (target,
10023 adjust_address (op0, VOIDmode,
10024 bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT),
10025 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
10026 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
10027 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10028 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
10030 return target;
10033 op0 = validize_mem (op0);
10035 if (MEM_P (op0) && REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10036 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
10038 op0 = extract_bit_field (op0, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp, packedp,
10039 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10040 ? NULL_RTX : target),
10041 ext_mode, ext_mode);
10043 /* If the result is a record type and BITSIZE is narrower than
10044 the mode of OP0, an integral mode, and this is a big endian
10045 machine, we must put the field into the high-order bits. */
10046 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10047 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
10048 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
10049 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
10050 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
10051 - bitsize, op0, 1);
10053 /* If the result type is BLKmode, store the data into a temporary
10054 of the appropriate type, but with the mode corresponding to the
10055 mode for the data we have (op0's mode). It's tempting to make
10056 this a constant type, since we know it's only being stored once,
10057 but that can cause problems if we are taking the address of this
10058 COMPONENT_REF because the MEM of any reference via that address
10059 will have flags corresponding to the type, which will not
10060 necessarily be constant. */
10061 if (mode == BLKmode)
10063 rtx new_rtx;
10065 new_rtx = assign_stack_temp_for_type (ext_mode,
10066 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (ext_mode),
10067 type);
10068 emit_move_insn (new_rtx, op0);
10069 op0 = copy_rtx (new_rtx);
10070 PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
10073 return op0;
10076 /* If the result is BLKmode, use that to access the object
10077 now as well. */
10078 if (mode == BLKmode)
10079 mode1 = BLKmode;
10081 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
10082 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10083 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10084 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10085 else
10086 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10088 if (op0 == orig_op0)
10089 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10091 /* If op0 is a temporary because of forcing to memory, pass only the
10092 type to set_mem_attributes so that the original expression is never
10093 marked as ADDRESSABLE through MEM_EXPR of the temporary. */
10094 if (mem_attrs_from_type)
10095 set_mem_attributes (op0, type, 0);
10096 else
10097 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 0);
10099 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10100 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
10102 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
10103 if (mode == mode1 || mode1 == BLKmode || mode1 == tmode
10104 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10105 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10106 return op0;
10107 else if (target == 0)
10108 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
10110 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
10111 return target;
10114 case OBJ_TYPE_REF:
10115 return expand_expr (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (exp), target, tmode, modifier);
10117 case CALL_EXPR:
10118 /* All valid uses of __builtin_va_arg_pack () are removed during
10119 inlining. */
10120 if (CALL_EXPR_VA_ARG_PACK (exp))
10121 error ("%Kinvalid use of %<__builtin_va_arg_pack ()%>", exp);
10123 tree fndecl = get_callee_fndecl (exp), attr;
10125 if (fndecl
10126 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("error",
10127 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
10128 error ("%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute error: %s",
10129 exp, identifier_to_locale (lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1)),
10130 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
10131 if (fndecl
10132 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("warning",
10133 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
10134 warning_at (tree_nonartificial_location (exp),
10135 0, "%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute warning: %s",
10136 exp, identifier_to_locale (lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1)),
10137 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
10139 /* Check for a built-in function. */
10140 if (fndecl && DECL_BUILT_IN (fndecl))
10142 gcc_assert (DECL_BUILT_IN_CLASS (fndecl) != BUILT_IN_FRONTEND);
10143 return expand_builtin (exp, target, subtarget, tmode, ignore);
10146 return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
10148 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10149 op0 = NULL_RTX;
10151 /* If we are converting to BLKmode, try to avoid an intermediate
10152 temporary by fetching an inner memory reference. */
10153 if (mode == BLKmode
10154 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
10155 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != BLKmode
10156 && handled_component_p (treeop0))
10158 enum machine_mode mode1;
10159 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
10160 tree offset;
10161 int unsignedp;
10162 int volatilep = 0;
10163 tree tem
10164 = get_inner_reference (treeop0, &bitsize, &bitpos,
10165 &offset, &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep,
10166 true);
10167 rtx orig_op0;
10169 /* ??? We should work harder and deal with non-zero offsets. */
10170 if (!offset
10171 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
10172 && bitsize >= 0
10173 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) == 0)
10175 /* See the normal_inner_ref case for the rationale. */
10176 orig_op0
10177 = expand_expr (tem,
10178 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
10179 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
10180 != INTEGER_CST)
10181 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10182 ? target : NULL_RTX),
10183 VOIDmode,
10184 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10185 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10186 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10187 ? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
10189 if (MEM_P (orig_op0))
10191 op0 = orig_op0;
10193 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
10194 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10195 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM
10196 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10197 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10198 else
10199 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10201 if (op0 == orig_op0)
10202 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10204 set_mem_attributes (op0, treeop0, 0);
10205 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10206 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
10208 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
10213 if (!op0)
10214 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0,
10215 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
10217 /* If the input and output modes are both the same, we are done. */
10218 if (mode == GET_MODE (op0))
10220 /* If neither mode is BLKmode, and both modes are the same size
10221 then we can use gen_lowpart. */
10222 else if (mode != BLKmode && GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode
10223 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)
10224 == GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (op0)))
10225 && !COMPLEX_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0)))
10227 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
10228 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
10229 temp = gen_lowpart_common (mode, op0);
10230 if (temp)
10231 op0 = temp;
10232 else
10234 if (!REG_P (op0) && !MEM_P (op0))
10235 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
10236 op0 = gen_lowpart (mode, op0);
10239 /* If both types are integral, convert from one mode to the other. */
10240 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
10241 op0 = convert_modes (mode, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
10242 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
10243 /* As a last resort, spill op0 to memory, and reload it in a
10244 different mode. */
10245 else if (!MEM_P (op0))
10247 /* If the operand is not a MEM, force it into memory. Since we
10248 are going to be changing the mode of the MEM, don't call
10249 force_const_mem for constants because we don't allow pool
10250 constants to change mode. */
10251 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
10253 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
10255 if (target == 0 || GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (inner_type))
10256 target
10257 = assign_stack_temp_for_type
10258 (TYPE_MODE (inner_type),
10259 GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)), inner_type);
10261 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
10262 op0 = target;
10265 /* At this point, OP0 is in the correct mode. If the output type is
10266 such that the operand is known to be aligned, indicate that it is.
10267 Otherwise, we need only be concerned about alignment for non-BLKmode
10268 results. */
10269 if (MEM_P (op0))
10271 enum insn_code icode;
10273 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10275 if (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (type))
10276 set_mem_align (op0, MAX (MEM_ALIGN (op0), TYPE_ALIGN (type)));
10277 else if (mode != BLKmode
10278 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
10279 /* If the target does have special handling for unaligned
10280 loads of mode then use them. */
10281 && ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
10282 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
10284 rtx reg, insn;
10286 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
10287 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
10288 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't
10289 fail. */
10290 reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10292 /* Nor can the insn generator. */
10293 insn = GEN_FCN (icode) (reg, op0);
10294 emit_insn (insn);
10295 return reg;
10297 else if (STRICT_ALIGNMENT
10298 && mode != BLKmode
10299 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
10301 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
10302 HOST_WIDE_INT temp_size
10303 = MAX (int_size_in_bytes (inner_type),
10304 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
10305 rtx new_rtx
10306 = assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, temp_size, type);
10307 rtx new_with_op0_mode
10308 = adjust_address (new_rtx, GET_MODE (op0), 0);
10310 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
10312 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode)
10313 emit_block_move (new_with_op0_mode, op0,
10314 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
10315 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10316 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
10317 else
10318 emit_move_insn (new_with_op0_mode, op0);
10320 op0 = new_rtx;
10323 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
10326 return op0;
10328 case MODIFY_EXPR:
10330 tree lhs = treeop0;
10331 tree rhs = treeop1;
10332 gcc_assert (ignore);
10334 /* Check for |= or &= of a bitfield of size one into another bitfield
10335 of size 1. In this case, (unless we need the result of the
10336 assignment) we can do this more efficiently with a
10337 test followed by an assignment, if necessary.
10339 ??? At this point, we can't get a BIT_FIELD_REF here. But if
10340 things change so we do, this code should be enhanced to
10341 support it. */
10342 if (TREE_CODE (lhs) == COMPONENT_REF
10343 && (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
10344 || TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
10345 && TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0) == lhs
10346 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1)) == COMPONENT_REF
10347 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 1)))
10348 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), 1))))
10350 rtx label = gen_label_rtx ();
10351 int value = TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR;
10352 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1),
10353 value ? label : 0,
10354 value ? 0 : label, -1);
10355 expand_assignment (lhs, build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (rhs), value),
10356 false);
10357 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10358 emit_label (label);
10359 return const0_rtx;
10362 expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, false);
10363 return const0_rtx;
10366 case ADDR_EXPR:
10367 return expand_expr_addr_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
10369 case REALPART_EXPR:
10370 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10371 return read_complex_part (op0, false);
10373 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
10374 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10375 return read_complex_part (op0, true);
10377 case RETURN_EXPR:
10378 case LABEL_EXPR:
10379 case GOTO_EXPR:
10380 case SWITCH_EXPR:
10381 case ASM_EXPR:
10382 /* Expanded in cfgexpand.c. */
10383 gcc_unreachable ();
10385 case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
10386 case CATCH_EXPR:
10387 case EH_FILTER_EXPR:
10388 case TRY_FINALLY_EXPR:
10389 /* Lowered by tree-eh.c. */
10390 gcc_unreachable ();
10392 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
10393 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
10394 case TARGET_EXPR:
10395 case CASE_LABEL_EXPR:
10396 case VA_ARG_EXPR:
10397 case BIND_EXPR:
10398 case INIT_EXPR:
10399 case CONJ_EXPR:
10400 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
10401 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
10402 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
10403 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
10404 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
10405 case LOOP_EXPR:
10406 case EXIT_EXPR:
10407 case COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR:
10408 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
10409 gcc_unreachable ();
10411 case FDESC_EXPR:
10412 /* Function descriptors are not valid except for as
10413 initialization constants, and should not be expanded. */
10414 gcc_unreachable ();
10416 case WITH_SIZE_EXPR:
10417 /* WITH_SIZE_EXPR expands to its first argument. The caller should
10418 have pulled out the size to use in whatever context it needed. */
10419 return expand_expr_real (treeop0, original_target, tmode,
10420 modifier, alt_rtl);
10422 default:
10423 return expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, target, tmode, modifier);
10427 /* Subroutine of above: reduce EXP to the precision of TYPE (in the
10428 signedness of TYPE), possibly returning the result in TARGET. */
10429 static rtx
10430 reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx exp, rtx target, tree type)
10432 HOST_WIDE_INT prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
10433 if (target && GET_MODE (target) != GET_MODE (exp))
10434 target = 0;
10435 /* For constant values, reduce using build_int_cst_type. */
10436 if (CONST_INT_P (exp))
10438 HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (exp);
10439 tree t = build_int_cst_type (type, value);
10440 return expand_expr (t, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10442 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10444 rtx mask = immed_double_int_const (double_int::mask (prec),
10445 GET_MODE (exp));
10446 return expand_and (GET_MODE (exp), exp, mask, target);
10448 else
10450 int count = GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (exp)) - prec;
10451 exp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp),
10452 exp, count, target, 0);
10453 return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp),
10454 exp, count, target, 0);
10458 /* Subroutine of above: returns 1 if OFFSET corresponds to an offset that
10459 when applied to the address of EXP produces an address known to be
10460 aligned more than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
10462 static int
10463 is_aligning_offset (const_tree offset, const_tree exp)
10465 /* Strip off any conversions. */
10466 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10467 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10469 /* We must now have a BIT_AND_EXPR with a constant that is one less than
10470 power of 2 and which is larger than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
10471 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != BIT_AND_EXPR
10472 || !host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1)
10473 || compare_tree_int (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1),
10474 BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT) <= 0
10475 || !exact_log2 (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1) + 1) < 0)
10476 return 0;
10478 /* Look at the first operand of BIT_AND_EXPR and strip any conversion.
10479 It must be NEGATE_EXPR. Then strip any more conversions. */
10480 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10481 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10482 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10484 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != NEGATE_EXPR)
10485 return 0;
10487 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10488 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10489 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10491 /* This must now be the address of EXP. */
10492 return TREE_CODE (offset) == ADDR_EXPR && TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0) == exp;
10495 /* Return the tree node if an ARG corresponds to a string constant or zero
10496 if it doesn't. If we return nonzero, set *PTR_OFFSET to the offset
10497 in bytes within the string that ARG is accessing. The type of the
10498 offset will be `sizetype'. */
10500 tree
10501 string_constant (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset)
10503 tree array, offset, lower_bound;
10504 STRIP_NOPS (arg);
10506 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR)
10508 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == STRING_CST)
10510 *ptr_offset = size_zero_node;
10511 return TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10513 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == VAR_DECL)
10515 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10516 offset = size_zero_node;
10518 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == ARRAY_REF)
10520 array = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0);
10521 offset = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 1);
10522 if (TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST
10523 && TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL)
10524 return 0;
10526 /* Check if the array has a nonzero lower bound. */
10527 lower_bound = array_ref_low_bound (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0));
10528 if (!integer_zerop (lower_bound))
10530 /* If the offset and base aren't both constants, return 0. */
10531 if (TREE_CODE (lower_bound) != INTEGER_CST)
10532 return 0;
10533 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != INTEGER_CST)
10534 return 0;
10535 /* Adjust offset by the lower bound. */
10536 offset = size_diffop (fold_convert (sizetype, offset),
10537 fold_convert (sizetype, lower_bound));
10540 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == MEM_REF)
10542 array = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0);
10543 offset = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 1);
10544 if (TREE_CODE (array) != ADDR_EXPR)
10545 return 0;
10546 array = TREE_OPERAND (array, 0);
10547 if (TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST
10548 && TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL)
10549 return 0;
10551 else
10552 return 0;
10554 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == PLUS_EXPR || TREE_CODE (arg) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
10556 tree arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10557 tree arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
10559 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
10560 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
10562 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == ADDR_EXPR
10563 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == STRING_CST
10564 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
10566 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0);
10567 offset = arg1;
10569 else if (TREE_CODE (arg1) == ADDR_EXPR
10570 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == STRING_CST
10571 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
10573 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0);
10574 offset = arg0;
10576 else
10577 return 0;
10579 else
10580 return 0;
10582 if (TREE_CODE (array) == STRING_CST)
10584 *ptr_offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
10585 return array;
10587 else if (TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL
10588 || TREE_CODE (array) == CONST_DECL)
10590 int length;
10592 /* Variables initialized to string literals can be handled too. */
10593 if (!const_value_known_p (array)
10594 || !DECL_INITIAL (array)
10595 || TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != STRING_CST)
10596 return 0;
10598 /* Avoid const char foo[4] = "abcde"; */
10599 if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array) == NULL_TREE
10600 || TREE_CODE (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array)) != INTEGER_CST
10601 || (length = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (DECL_INITIAL (array))) <= 0
10602 || compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) < 0)
10603 return 0;
10605 /* If variable is bigger than the string literal, OFFSET must be constant
10606 and inside of the bounds of the string literal. */
10607 offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
10608 if (compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) > 0
10609 && (! host_integerp (offset, 1)
10610 || compare_tree_int (offset, length) >= 0))
10611 return 0;
10613 *ptr_offset = offset;
10614 return DECL_INITIAL (array);
10617 return 0;
10620 /* Generate code to calculate OPS, and exploded expression
10621 using a store-flag instruction and return an rtx for the result.
10622 OPS reflects a comparison.
10624 If TARGET is nonzero, store the result there if convenient.
10626 Return zero if there is no suitable set-flag instruction
10627 available on this machine.
10629 Once expand_expr has been called on the arguments of the comparison,
10630 we are committed to doing the store flag, since it is not safe to
10631 re-evaluate the expression. We emit the store-flag insn by calling
10632 emit_store_flag, but only expand the arguments if we have a reason
10633 to believe that emit_store_flag will be successful. If we think that
10634 it will, but it isn't, we have to simulate the store-flag with a
10635 set/jump/set sequence. */
10637 static rtx
10638 do_store_flag (sepops ops, rtx target, enum machine_mode mode)
10640 enum rtx_code code;
10641 tree arg0, arg1, type;
10642 tree tem;
10643 enum machine_mode operand_mode;
10644 int unsignedp;
10645 rtx op0, op1;
10646 rtx subtarget = target;
10647 location_t loc = ops->location;
10649 arg0 = ops->op0;
10650 arg1 = ops->op1;
10652 /* Don't crash if the comparison was erroneous. */
10653 if (arg0 == error_mark_node || arg1 == error_mark_node)
10654 return const0_rtx;
10656 type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
10657 operand_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
10658 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
10660 /* We won't bother with BLKmode store-flag operations because it would mean
10661 passing a lot of information to emit_store_flag. */
10662 if (operand_mode == BLKmode)
10663 return 0;
10665 /* We won't bother with store-flag operations involving function pointers
10666 when function pointers must be canonicalized before comparisons. */
10667 #ifdef HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
10668 if (HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
10669 && ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg0)) == POINTER_TYPE
10670 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg0)))
10671 == FUNCTION_TYPE))
10672 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg1)) == POINTER_TYPE
10673 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg1)))
10674 == FUNCTION_TYPE))))
10675 return 0;
10676 #endif
10678 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
10679 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
10681 /* For vector typed comparisons emit code to generate the desired
10682 all-ones or all-zeros mask. Conveniently use the VEC_COND_EXPR
10683 expander for this. */
10684 if (TREE_CODE (ops->type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
10686 tree ifexp = build2 (ops->code, ops->type, arg0, arg1);
10687 tree if_true = constant_boolean_node (true, ops->type);
10688 tree if_false = constant_boolean_node (false, ops->type);
10689 return expand_vec_cond_expr (ops->type, ifexp, if_true, if_false, target);
10692 /* Get the rtx comparison code to use. We know that EXP is a comparison
10693 operation of some type. Some comparisons against 1 and -1 can be
10694 converted to comparisons with zero. Do so here so that the tests
10695 below will be aware that we have a comparison with zero. These
10696 tests will not catch constants in the first operand, but constants
10697 are rarely passed as the first operand. */
10699 switch (ops->code)
10701 case EQ_EXPR:
10702 code = EQ;
10703 break;
10704 case NE_EXPR:
10705 code = NE;
10706 break;
10707 case LT_EXPR:
10708 if (integer_onep (arg1))
10709 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
10710 else
10711 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
10712 break;
10713 case LE_EXPR:
10714 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
10715 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = LT;
10716 else
10717 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
10718 break;
10719 case GT_EXPR:
10720 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
10721 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = GE;
10722 else
10723 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
10724 break;
10725 case GE_EXPR:
10726 if (integer_onep (arg1))
10727 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
10728 else
10729 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
10730 break;
10732 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
10733 code = UNORDERED;
10734 break;
10735 case ORDERED_EXPR:
10736 code = ORDERED;
10737 break;
10738 case UNLT_EXPR:
10739 code = UNLT;
10740 break;
10741 case UNLE_EXPR:
10742 code = UNLE;
10743 break;
10744 case UNGT_EXPR:
10745 code = UNGT;
10746 break;
10747 case UNGE_EXPR:
10748 code = UNGE;
10749 break;
10750 case UNEQ_EXPR:
10751 code = UNEQ;
10752 break;
10753 case LTGT_EXPR:
10754 code = LTGT;
10755 break;
10757 default:
10758 gcc_unreachable ();
10761 /* Put a constant second. */
10762 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == REAL_CST || TREE_CODE (arg0) == INTEGER_CST
10763 || TREE_CODE (arg0) == FIXED_CST)
10765 tem = arg0; arg0 = arg1; arg1 = tem;
10766 code = swap_condition (code);
10769 /* If this is an equality or inequality test of a single bit, we can
10770 do this by shifting the bit being tested to the low-order bit and
10771 masking the result with the constant 1. If the condition was EQ,
10772 we xor it with 1. This does not require an scc insn and is faster
10773 than an scc insn even if we have it.
10775 The code to make this transformation was moved into fold_single_bit_test,
10776 so we just call into the folder and expand its result. */
10778 if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
10779 && integer_zerop (arg1)
10780 && (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) != 1 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)))
10782 gimple srcstmt = get_def_for_expr (arg0, BIT_AND_EXPR);
10783 if (srcstmt
10784 && integer_pow2p (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt)))
10786 enum tree_code tcode = code == NE ? NE_EXPR : EQ_EXPR;
10787 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
10788 tree temp = fold_build2_loc (loc, BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (arg1),
10789 gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt),
10790 gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt));
10791 temp = fold_single_bit_test (loc, tcode, temp, arg1, type);
10792 if (temp)
10793 return expand_expr (temp, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10797 if (! get_subtarget (target)
10798 || GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode)
10799 subtarget = 0;
10801 expand_operands (arg0, arg1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10803 if (target == 0)
10804 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10806 /* Try a cstore if possible. */
10807 return emit_store_flag_force (target, code, op0, op1,
10808 operand_mode, unsignedp,
10809 (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) == 1
10810 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)) ? -1 : 1);
10814 /* Stubs in case we haven't got a casesi insn. */
10815 #ifndef HAVE_casesi
10816 # define HAVE_casesi 0
10817 # define gen_casesi(a, b, c, d, e) (0)
10818 # define CODE_FOR_casesi CODE_FOR_nothing
10819 #endif
10821 /* Attempt to generate a casesi instruction. Returns 1 if successful,
10822 0 otherwise (i.e. if there is no casesi instruction). */
10824 try_casesi (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
10825 rtx table_label, rtx default_label, rtx fallback_label)
10827 struct expand_operand ops[5];
10828 enum machine_mode index_mode = SImode;
10829 rtx op1, op2, index;
10831 if (! HAVE_casesi)
10832 return 0;
10834 /* Convert the index to SImode. */
10835 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (index_type)) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode))
10837 enum machine_mode omode = TYPE_MODE (index_type);
10838 rtx rangertx = expand_normal (range);
10840 /* We must handle the endpoints in the original mode. */
10841 index_expr = build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
10842 index_expr, minval);
10843 minval = integer_zero_node;
10844 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
10845 if (default_label)
10846 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (rangertx, index, LTU, NULL_RTX,
10847 omode, 1, default_label);
10848 /* Now we can safely truncate. */
10849 index = convert_to_mode (index_mode, index, 0);
10851 else
10853 if (TYPE_MODE (index_type) != index_mode)
10855 index_type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (index_mode, 0);
10856 index_expr = fold_convert (index_type, index_expr);
10859 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
10862 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10864 op1 = expand_normal (minval);
10865 op2 = expand_normal (range);
10867 create_input_operand (&ops[0], index, index_mode);
10868 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[1], op1, TREE_TYPE (minval));
10869 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[2], op2, TREE_TYPE (range));
10870 create_fixed_operand (&ops[3], table_label);
10871 create_fixed_operand (&ops[4], (default_label
10872 ? default_label
10873 : fallback_label));
10874 expand_jump_insn (CODE_FOR_casesi, 5, ops);
10875 return 1;
10878 /* Attempt to generate a tablejump instruction; same concept. */
10879 #ifndef HAVE_tablejump
10880 #define HAVE_tablejump 0
10881 #define gen_tablejump(x, y) (0)
10882 #endif
10884 /* Subroutine of the next function.
10886 INDEX is the value being switched on, with the lowest value
10887 in the table already subtracted.
10888 MODE is its expected mode (needed if INDEX is constant).
10889 RANGE is the length of the jump table.
10890 TABLE_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx for the table itself.
10892 DEFAULT_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx to jump to if the
10893 index value is out of range. */
10895 static void
10896 do_tablejump (rtx index, enum machine_mode mode, rtx range, rtx table_label,
10897 rtx default_label)
10899 rtx temp, vector;
10901 if (INTVAL (range) > cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents)
10902 cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents = INTVAL (range);
10904 /* Do an unsigned comparison (in the proper mode) between the index
10905 expression and the value which represents the length of the range.
10906 Since we just finished subtracting the lower bound of the range
10907 from the index expression, this comparison allows us to simultaneously
10908 check that the original index expression value is both greater than
10909 or equal to the minimum value of the range and less than or equal to
10910 the maximum value of the range. */
10912 if (default_label)
10913 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index, range, GTU, NULL_RTX, mode, 1,
10914 default_label);
10916 /* If index is in range, it must fit in Pmode.
10917 Convert to Pmode so we can index with it. */
10918 if (mode != Pmode)
10919 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 1);
10921 /* Don't let a MEM slip through, because then INDEX that comes
10922 out of PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS won't be a valid address,
10923 and break_out_memory_refs will go to work on it and mess it up. */
10924 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
10925 if (flag_pic && !REG_P (index))
10926 index = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, index);
10927 #endif
10929 /* ??? The only correct use of CASE_VECTOR_MODE is the one inside the
10930 GET_MODE_SIZE, because this indicates how large insns are. The other
10931 uses should all be Pmode, because they are addresses. This code
10932 could fail if addresses and insns are not the same size. */
10933 index = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
10934 gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, index,
10935 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (CASE_VECTOR_MODE))),
10936 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, table_label));
10937 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
10938 if (flag_pic)
10939 index = PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS (index);
10940 else
10941 #endif
10942 index = memory_address (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
10943 temp = gen_reg_rtx (CASE_VECTOR_MODE);
10944 vector = gen_const_mem (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
10945 convert_move (temp, vector, 0);
10947 emit_jump_insn (gen_tablejump (temp, table_label));
10949 /* If we are generating PIC code or if the table is PC-relative, the
10950 table and JUMP_INSN must be adjacent, so don't output a BARRIER. */
10951 if (! CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE && ! flag_pic)
10952 emit_barrier ();
10956 try_tablejump (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
10957 rtx table_label, rtx default_label)
10959 rtx index;
10961 if (! HAVE_tablejump)
10962 return 0;
10964 index_expr = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
10965 fold_convert (index_type, index_expr),
10966 fold_convert (index_type, minval));
10967 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
10968 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10970 do_tablejump (index, TYPE_MODE (index_type),
10971 convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (index_type),
10972 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
10973 expand_normal (range),
10974 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range))),
10975 table_label, default_label);
10976 return 1;
10979 /* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx for a VECTOR_CST tree. */
10980 static rtx
10981 const_vector_from_tree (tree exp)
10983 rtvec v;
10984 unsigned i;
10985 int units;
10986 tree elt;
10987 enum machine_mode inner, mode;
10989 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
10991 if (initializer_zerop (exp))
10992 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
10994 units = GET_MODE_NUNITS (mode);
10995 inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
10997 v = rtvec_alloc (units);
10999 for (i = 0; i < VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp); ++i)
11001 elt = VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i);
11003 if (TREE_CODE (elt) == REAL_CST)
11004 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (elt),
11005 inner);
11006 else if (TREE_CODE (elt) == FIXED_CST)
11007 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (elt),
11008 inner);
11009 else
11010 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = immed_double_int_const (tree_to_double_int (elt),
11011 inner);
11014 return gen_rtx_CONST_VECTOR (mode, v);
11017 /* Build a decl for a personality function given a language prefix. */
11019 tree
11020 build_personality_function (const char *lang)
11022 const char *unwind_and_version;
11023 tree decl, type;
11024 char *name;
11026 switch (targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options))
11028 case UI_NONE:
11029 return NULL;
11030 case UI_SJLJ:
11031 unwind_and_version = "_sj0";
11032 break;
11033 case UI_DWARF2:
11034 case UI_TARGET:
11035 unwind_and_version = "_v0";
11036 break;
11037 case UI_SEH:
11038 unwind_and_version = "_seh0";
11039 break;
11040 default:
11041 gcc_unreachable ();
11044 name = ACONCAT (("__", lang, "_personality", unwind_and_version, NULL));
11046 type = build_function_type_list (integer_type_node, integer_type_node,
11047 long_long_unsigned_type_node,
11048 ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node, NULL_TREE);
11049 decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL,
11050 get_identifier (name), type);
11051 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = 1;
11052 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
11053 TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = 1;
11055 /* Zap the nonsensical SYMBOL_REF_DECL for this. What we're left with
11056 are the flags assigned by targetm.encode_section_info. */
11057 SET_SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), NULL);
11059 return decl;
11062 /* Extracts the personality function of DECL and returns the corresponding
11063 libfunc. */
11066 get_personality_function (tree decl)
11068 tree personality = DECL_FUNCTION_PERSONALITY (decl);
11069 enum eh_personality_kind pk;
11071 pk = function_needs_eh_personality (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
11072 if (pk == eh_personality_none)
11073 return NULL;
11075 if (!personality
11076 && pk == eh_personality_any)
11077 personality = lang_hooks.eh_personality ();
11079 if (pk == eh_personality_lang)
11080 gcc_assert (personality != NULL_TREE);
11082 return XEXP (DECL_RTL (personality), 0);
11085 #include "gt-expr.h"